679478
26
Verklein
Vergroot
Pagina terug
1/308
Pagina verder
Owners Manual
for advanced features
Digital Camera
Model No. DMC-LX10
SQW0721
M0916KZ0
Message Display 289
Please read these instructions carefully before using this product,
and save this manual for future use.
Q&A Troubleshooting 291
Finding the information you need 2
Contents 4
Contents by Function 10
Menu list 169
Register online at
http://shop.panasonic.com/support
(U.S. customers only)
2
SQW0721
Finding the information you need
In this “Owner’s Manual for advanced features”, you can find the information you need
from the following pages.
By clicking a page number, you can jump to the linked page and quickly find the
information.
Search from “Contents”
4 -
Search from the list of function
names
“Contents by Function”
10 -
Search from “Names and
Functions of Main Parts”
16 -
Search from “List of monitor
displays”
283 -
Search from the list of
on-screen messages
“Message displays”
289 -
Search from the menu list
“Menu list”
169 -
[Rec] ............................ 169
[Motion Picture]............ 187
[Custom] ...................... 189
[Setup] ........................ 198
[Playback] .................... 207
Search from “Q&A
Troubleshooting”
291 -
For details on how to use this manual,
see the next page.
Wi-Fi
®
function 227
3
SQW0721
How to use this manual
Click this icon to jump to “Finding the information you need”.
Click this icon to jump to “Contents”.
Click this icon to jump to “Menu list”.
Click this icon to return to the previously displayed page.
Recording mode icons
Recording mode:
In Recording modes that show icons in black, you can select and execute indicated
menus and functions.
has different functions depending on the recording mode that is registered.
• Click a cross reference in the text to jump to the corresponding page.
About the symbols in the text
Indicates that the menu can be set by pressing [MENU/SET] button.
Indicates that the Wi-Fi setting can be made by pressing [Wi-Fi] button.
Tips for skillful use and points for recording.
(→00) Indicates the reference page. Click to go to the corresponding page.
Click to view the description on the next page.
In this Owner’s Manual, steps for setting a menu item are described as follows:
Example: To change the [Quality] setting from [ ] to [ ] in the [Rec] menu
[Rec] → [Quality] → [ ]
• In this manual, ring, dial and lever operations are illustrated as below.
Turn the control ring
Rotate the rear dial
Rotate the zoom lever
4
SQW0721
Contents
Finding the information you need ..... 2
How to use this manual ...................... 3
Before use ......................................... 13
Standard Accessories ...................... 15
Before Use
Names and Functions
of Main Parts ..................................... 16
Preparations
Attaching the Hand Strap ................. 18
Charging battery ............................... 19
Inserting the battery ...................................20
Charging the battery ..................................21
Inserting and removing the card
(optional) ............................................ 24
About the Card .................................. 25
Formatting the card (initialization)..............26
Estimated recording capacity
(number of pictures/recording time) ........... 26
Setting the clock ............................... 28
Changing time settings ..............................29
Contents by Function ....................... 10
Holding the camera ........................... 30
Adjusting the angle
of the monitor .................................... 31
Buttons/Dials/Levers
Used for Recording ........................... 32
Zoom Lever (Use Zoom)............................32
Shutter button (Taking pictures) ................. 33
Motion picture button
(Recording motion pictures).......................34
Mode dial (Select the recording mode) ...... 34
Control ring / Aperture ring / Rear dial .......35
Cursor button / [MENU/SET] button
(Selecting/setting items) ............................37
[DISP.] button
(Switching the display information) ............ 37
Touch screen (Touch operations).... 39
Touching the screen and recording
(Touch Shutter function).............................40
Easily Optimizing the Brightness for a
Specified Area ([Touch AE]) .......................41
Basics
Setting the menu ............................... 42
Calling frequently-used
menus instantly
(Quick Menu) ..................................... 44
Change the Quick Menu to your
preferred item ............................................45
Assigning frequently used
functions to the buttons
(Function buttons) ............................ 46
Using the function buttons during
recording .................................................... 47
Using the function buttons during
playback.....................................................48
Entering Text ..................................... 49
5
SQW0721
Contents
Recording mode
Taking pictures with
automatic settings
(Intelligent Auto Mode) ..................... 50
Taking pictures using a handheld camera
([iHandheld Night Shot]) ............................53
Combining pictures into a single still
picture with rich gradation ([iHDR]) ............ 54
Recording images by changing the
brightness (exposure) or color tone ........... 55
Defocusing the background
(Defocus control function) .......................... 56
Taking Pictures of Yourself
[Self Shot] .......................................... 57
Changing the way the shutter is
released .....................................................59
Taking pictures after
automatically setting the
aperture value and shutter speed
(Program AE Mode)........................... 61
Taking pictures by setting the
aperture value and shutter speed ... 62
Taking pictures by setting the aperture
value (Aperture-Priority AE Mode) .............62
Taking pictures by setting the shutter
speed (Shutter-Priority AE Mode) ..............63
Taking pictures by setting the
aperture value and shutter speed
(Manual Exposure Mode) ..........................64
Checking the effects of the
aperture value and shutter speed
(Preview Mode)..........................................66
Easily set aperture / shutter speed for
suitable exposure (One Push AE)..............68
Recording panorama pictures
(Panorama Shot Mode) ..................... 69
Taking pictures
according to the scene
(Scene Guide Mode) ......................... 72
Types of Scene Guide Mode .....................73
Taking Pictures with
different picture effects
(Creative Control Mode) ................... 76
Types of picture effects .............................. 77
Recording motion pictures
by setting the aperture value/
shutter speed
(Creative Video Mode) ...................... 82
Recording Slow Motion Pictures
([High Speed Video]) .................................83
Minimizing operational sounds during
motion picture recording ............................84
Registering your own
settings and recording
(Custom Mode) .................................. 85
Registering your own settings
([Cust.Set Mem.]).......................................85
Recording using registered custom set .....86
6
SQW0721
Contents
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus ..... 87
Set the focusing operation to be
performed when the shutter button is
pressed halfway (AFS, AFF, AFC) .............88
Switching [AF Mode] .................................. 89
Changing the position and size
of the AF area ............................................95
Optimizing the focus and brightness
for a touched position ................................98
Taking close-up pictures
(Macro recording) ............................. 99
Taking pictures with
Manual Focus .................................. 100
Taking pictures by locking
the focus and/or exposure
(AF/AE Lock) ................................... 102
Taking pictures with Exposure
Compensation ................................. 103
Setting the ISO Sensitivity ............. 104
Adjusting the White Balance ......... 106
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos ..................... 110
Notes on the 4K Photo function ............... 114
Selecting pictures from 4K burst
file and saving ................................. 117
Adjusting the focus after recording
([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking]) .... 121
Recording using [Post Focus] .................. 121
Select the focus point and save the
picture ([Post Focus])...............................123
Combine multiple pictures to increase
the focus range ([Focus Stacking]) .......... 124
Selecting a Drive Mode ................... 126
Burst function ........................................... 127
Taking pictures with self-timer..................129
Taking Pictures While
Adjusting a Setting Automatically
(Bracket Recording) ........................ 130
Exposure Bracket ....................................131
Aperture Bracket ...................................... 132
Focus Bracket .......................................... 132
Taking pictures
automatically at set intervals
[Time Lapse Shot] ........................... 133
Creating stop motion animation
[Stop Motion Animation] ................ 135
7
SQW0721
Contents
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter ............................... 138
Using Zoom ..................................... 140
Zoom types and use ................................140
Using the zoom by performing touch
operations (Touch zoom) .........................143
Taking pictures with flash .............. 144
Setting the Flash Functions ........... 146
Changing Flash Mode..............................146
Setting the 2nd curtain sync ....................148
Adjusting the flash output ........................148
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/
4K Motion Picture ........................... 149
Setting the format, picture size and
recording frame rate ................................151
Adjusting the focus while recording
motion pictures ([Continuous AF]) ...........153
Pan or zoom while recording
with the camera in a fixed position
[4K Live Cropping] .......................... 154
Taking still pictures while
a motion picture is being
recorded ........................................... 157
Recording Snap Movies ................. 158
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing your pictures ..................... 161
Viewing motion pictures ................ 162
Capturing still pictures from motion
pictures ....................................................163
Switching the Playback Method .... 164
Zooming in and viewing
“Playback Zoom”......................................164
Viewing a list of pictures
“Multi Playback” .......................................164
Viewing pictures by their recording date
“Calendar Playback” ................................165
Viewing group pictures .................. 166
Deleting pictures ............................. 168
8
SQW0721
Contents
Wi-Fi
What you can do with the
Wi-Fi
®
function ................................ 227
Wi-Fi Function ................................. 228
Operating the camera by
connecting it to a smartphone ....... 231
Installing the smartphone/tablet app
“Panasonic Image App” ...........................231
Connecting to a smartphone....................232
Taking pictures via a smartphone
(remote recording) ...................................236
Playing back pictures in the camera
on a smartphone ...................................... 237
Saving pictures in the camera to a
smartphone .............................................. 237
Sending pictures in the camera to
social networking services .......................238
Adding location information to pictures
in the camera from a smartphone ............ 238
Combining motion pictures recorded
with Snap Movie according to your
preference on a smartphone....................240
Displaying still pictures on a TV .... 241
Sending pictures ............................. 242
Sending pictures to a
smartphone ..................................... 245
Wireless printing ............................. 246
Sending pictures to AV device ....... 247
Sending pictures to a PC ............... 248
Using WEB services ....................... 250
When sending images to WEB service....250
When sending images to
[Cloud Sync. Service] ..............................253
Using “LUMIX CLUB” ..................... 254
About the [LUMIX CLUB] ......................... 254
About connections ......................... 259
Connecting via a wireless access point
([Via Network]) .........................................260
Connecting directly ([Direct]) ...................263
Connecting quickly with the same
settings as used previously
([Select a destination from History] /
[Select a destination from Favorite]) ........ 264
[Wi-Fi Setup] .................................... 266
Using Menu Functions
Menu list .......................................... 169
[Rec] ........................................................169
[Motion Picture] ........................................ 187
[Custom] ..................................................189
[Setup] .....................................................198
[Playback] ................................................207
9
SQW0721
Contents
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures ......... 268
Viewing 4K motion pictures .....................268
Storing 4K motion pictures.......................269
Viewing on TV screen ..................... 270
VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™) ....272
Storing recorded still pictures and
motion pictures on your PC ........... 273
Downloading software .............................274
Copying still pictures and motion
pictures ....................................................276
Storing recorded still pictures and
motion pictures in the recorder ..... 278
Printing ............................................ 279
Printing with date and text .......................281
Others
Optional accessories ...................... 282
Using the AC adaptor (optional)
and DC coupler (optional) instead
of the battery ............................................ 282
List of monitor display ................... 283
Message displays ........................... 289
Q&A Troubleshooting .................... 291
Usage cautions and notes ............. 300
10
SQW0721
Contents by Function
Recording
Recording mode ...........................................34
[Preview] ....................................................... 66
Panorama Shot Mode ...................................69
Macro recording ............................................99
Aperture Bracket .........................................132
Focus Bracket .............................................132
[Time Lapse Shot] .......................................133
[Stop Motion Animation] ..............................135
[Multi Exp.] .................................................. 179
[Silent Mode] ...............................................189
4K Photo
[4K PHOTO]................................................ 110
[Post Focus] recording ................................121
Focus (AF/MF)
Auto Focus ...................................................87
AF Mode .......................................................89
Adjusting the AF area position ...................... 95
Manual Focus .............................................100
AF/AE Lock .................................................102
Drive
Drive Mode .................................................126
Burst function ..............................................127
[Self Timer] .................................................129
Recording
Exposure
[Touch AE] ....................................................41
[One Push AE] ..............................................68
AF/AE Lock .................................................102
Exposure Compensation ............................103
ISO sensitivity ............................................. 104
Exposure Bracket .......................................131
[Metering Mode] ..........................................175
Picture Quality and Color Tone
White Balance ............................................106
[Photo Style] ...............................................170
[Filter Settings] ............................................172
[Picture Size] ..............................................174
[Quality] ......................................................174
[Highlight Shadow] ......................................176
[i.Dynamic] .................................................. 177
[i.Resolution] ............................................... 177
[HDR] .......................................................... 178
[Long Shtr NR] ............................................ 182
[Diffraction Compensation] .........................182
[Color Space] .............................................. 183
Flash
[Flash Mode] ............................................... 146
2nd curtain synchro ....................................148
[Flash Adjust.] .............................................148
Motion Picture
Creative Video Mode ....................................82
[High Speed Video] ....................................... 83
[Silent Operation] .......................................... 84
Motion pictures in 4K ..................................149
[Rec Format] ............................................... 151
[Rec Quality] ...............................................151
[4K Live Cropping] ......................................154
Taking still pictures while a motion picture
is being recorded ........................................157
[Snap Movie] ...............................................158
Motion Picture
Audio
[Wind Noise Canceller] ...............................188
Screen settings
[Center Marker] ...........................................193
[Zebra Pattern] ............................................194
[Monochrome Live View] ............................195
11
SQW0721
Contents by Function
Playback
Picture playback .........................................161
Motion picture playback .............................. 162
Playback Zoom ........................................... 164
Multi Playback ............................................164
Delete .........................................................168
[Auto Review] .............................................196
Display/playback settings
[Slide Show] ................................................208
[Rotate]/[Rotate Disp.] ........................222, 223
Edit
[Post Focus] ................................................123
[Focus Stacking] .........................................124
[RAW Processing] .......................................212
[4K PHOTO Bulk Saving] ...........................215
[Light Composition] ..................................... 215
[Clear Retouch] ...........................................217
[Resize] ....................................................... 221
[Cropping] ...................................................222
Playback
Adding information
[Location Logging] ...................................... 211
[Title Edit] .................................................... 218
[Text Stamp] ................................................ 219
Image settings
[Favorite] .....................................................223
[Print Set] .................................................... 224
[Protect] ......................................................225
Basic settings
[Format] ........................................................26
[Clock Set] ....................................................28
Display switching ....................................37, 38
How to set menu items .................................42
[Q.MENU] .....................................................44
[Beep] .........................................................200
[Economy] ...................................................202
[Reset] (initialization) ..................................205
Setup/Custom
Customization
[CUSTOM] in the Quick Menu ......................45
Function buttons ...........................................46
Custom Mode ...............................................85
[Custom] menu ...........................................189
12
SQW0721
Contents by Function
PC
Transferring images to a PC ....................... 273
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” ..................................274
SILKYPIX ....................................................275
TV
Playing Back Pictures on a TV Screen .......270
[VIERA Link] ...............................................272
Connecting with other devices
Recorder
Dubbing ......................................................278
Printer
PictBridge ...................................................279
Connect
“Image App” ................................................231
[WPS (Push-Button)] ..........................260, 263
Direct connection ........................................ 263
Image App
Remote recording .......................................236
Saving images ............................................237
Sending images .................................. 238, 245
Sending and adding location information ...238
Combining motion pictures recorded with
[Snap Movie] ...............................................240
Wi-Fi
In combination with other devices
Playing back pictures on a TV ....................241
Printing images ........................................... 246
Sending images to an AV device ................247
Sending images to a PC ............................. 248
Sending images to a WEB service .............250
Using [Cloud Sync. Service] .......................253
13
SQW0721
Before Use
Before use
Camera handling
Keep the camera away from excessive vibration, force, or
pressure.
Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which may
damage the lens, monitor, or camera body.
This may also cause the camera to malfunction or prevent
recording.
• Dropping or hitting the camera against a hard surface
• Sitting down with the camera in your pants pocket or forcing it
into a full bag
• Adding accessories to the camera strap
• Pushing with excessive force on the lens or monitor
The camera is not dust resistant, splash resistant, or
waterproof.
Avoid using the camera in places with excessive dust or sand,
or where water can come into contact with the camera.
Avoid using the camera under the following conditions, which
present a risk that sand, water, or foreign material may enter
the camera through the lens or openings around buttons. Be
especially careful because these conditions may damage the
camera, and such damage may not be repairable.
• In extremely dusty or sandy places
• In the rain or by the shore, where the camera may be exposed
to water
Condensation (When the lens or the monitor is fogged up)
Condensation may occur when the camera is exposed to sudden changes of
temperature or humidity. Avoid these conditions, which may make the lens or monitor
dirty, cause mold, or damage the camera.
If condensation does occur, turn off the camera and wait about two hours before using
it. Once the camera adjusts to the surrounding temperature, the fogging will clear
naturally.
14
SQW0721
Before Use
Before use
Always take a test shot first
Before important events when you will use the camera (at weddings, for example), always
take a test shot to make sure that pictures and sound record correctly.
No compensation for missed shots
We cannot compensate for missed shots if technical problems with the camera or card
prevent recording.
Carefully observe copyright laws
Unauthorized use of recordings that contain works with copyright for purposes other than
personal use is prohibited under copyright law. Recording of certain material may be
restricted even for the purpose of personal use.
Also refer to “Usage cautions and notes” (→300)
Before using the camera, make sure all accessories specified in the attached
“Basic Owners Manual” are supplied.
For details on optional accessories (→282)
15
SQW0721
Before Use
Standard Accessories
Check that all the accessories are supplied before using the camera.
The accessories and their shape will differ depending on the country or area where the
camera was purchased.
For details on the accessories, refer to “Basic Owner’s Manual”.
Battery Pack is indicated as battery pack or battery in the text.
SD Memory Card, SDHC Memory Card and SDXC Memory Card are indicated as card
in the text.
Please dispose of all packaging appropriately.
Keep small parts in a safe place out of the reach of children.
Optional accessories
Cards are optional.
16
SQW0721
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
1
Shutter button (→33)
2
Zoom lever (→32)
3
Motion picture button (→34)
4
Rear dial (→35)
5
Camera [ON/OFF] switch (→28)
6
Mode dial (→34)
7
Stereo microphone (→30)
Be careful not to cover the microphone
with your finger. Doing so may make
sound difficult to record.
8
Flash open lever (→144)
9
Flash (→144)
10
Strap eyelet (→18)
11
Aperture ring (→35)
12
Control ring (→35)
13
Lens barrel
14
Lens
15
Self-timer indicator (→129) /
AF Assist Lamp (→191)
1 2 3
45678
9
10
11
121314
15
17
SQW0721
Before Use
Names and Functions of Main Parts
10
Strap eyelet (→18)
16
Charging lamp (→22) /
Wi-Fi
®
connection lamp (→228)
17
[ ] ([Post Focus]) button (→121) /
[Fn2] button (→46)
18
[Q.MENU/ ] (Cancel) button (→44) /
[
] (Delete) button (→168) /
[Fn3] button (→46)
19
[ ] (4K photo mode) button (→110) /
[Fn1] button (→46)
20
[ ] (Playback) button (→161)
21
Cursor button (→37)
[
] (Exposure compensation) ( )
(→103)
[
] (White Balance) ( ) (→106)
[
] (Drive Mode) ( ) (→126)
[
] (Focus Mode) ( ) (→87, 99, 100)
22
[MENU/SET] button (→37)
23
[DISP.] button (→37)
24
[HDMI] socket (→270)
25
[USB/CHARGE] socket (→21, 276, 279)
26
Release lever (→20)
27
DC coupler cover (→282)
When using an AC adaptor, ensure that
the Panasonic DC coupler (optional) and
AC adaptor (optional) are used.
28
Card/Battery door (→20, 24)
29
Tripod mount (→303)
Do not attach this unit to tripods that
have screws with a length of 5.5 mm
(0.22 inch) or more. Doing so may
damage this unit or the unit may not be
secured properly on the tripod.
30
Touch screen (→39) / monitor (→283)
31
Speaker (→30)
Function buttons [Fn4] to [Fn8]
• Buttons [Fn4] to [Fn8] (→46) are
touch icons. They can be displayed by
touching the [
] tab on the recording
screen.
23
17
18
19
21
20
22
16
24
25
262728293031
10
18
SQW0721
Preparations
Attaching the Hand Strap
We recommend attaching the hand strap when using the camera to prevent it from
dropping.
Strap eyelet
19
SQW0721
Preparations
Charging battery
Always use the dedicated AC adaptor (supplied), USB connection cable (supplied), and
battery for this camera.
Always charge before first use! (battery shipped uncharged)
Charge the battery while it is in the camera.
Camera status Charge
Turn off Yes
Turn on No
About batteries that you can use with this unit
It has been found that counterfeit battery packs which look very similar to the
genuine products are made available to purchase in some markets. Some of
these battery packs are not adequately protected with internal protection to
meet the requirements of appropriate safety standards. There is a possibility
that these battery packs may lead to fire or explosion. Please be advised that
we are not liable for any accident or failure occurring as a result of use of a
counterfeit battery pack. To ensure that safe products are used we recommend
that a genuine Panasonic battery pack is used.
20
SQW0721
Preparations
Charging battery
Inserting the battery
To charge the battery, insert it into the camera.
1
Slide the release lever to the
[OPEN] position and open the
card/battery door
Release lever
[OPEN] [LOCK]
2
Insert the battery all the way
• Insert the battery all the way firmly and
check that it is locked by lever.
3
Close the card/battery door
and then slide the release
lever to the [LOCK] position
Make sure to insert the battery in the
correct orientation.
Lever
To remove battery
Move the lever in the card/battery
compartment in the direction of the arrow.
Always use genuine Panasonic batteries.
If you use other batteries, we cannot guarantee the quality of this product.
To remove the battery, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the screen goes
off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card or recorded
data.)
Remove battery from camera after use.
Keep the battery in a plastic bag, making sure that it is kept away from metallic objects (such as
clips) when carrying or storing it.
The unusable battery should be discarded in accordance with battery recycling laws.
Call the RBRC hotline at 1-800-822-8837 for information.
21
SQW0721
Preparations
Charging battery
Charging the battery
We recommend charging in a location where the ambient temperature is between 10 °C
and 30 °C (50 °F to 86 °F) (same for the battery temperature).
Insert the battery into the camera.
Make sure that the camera is turned off.
The battery can be charged from an outlet or through a PC.
USB connection cable (supplied)
AC adaptor (supplied)
Computer
Getting ready: Turn on the computer.
When charging the camera, connect the USB connection cable (supplied) to the
[USB/CHARGE] socket.
[USB/CHARGE] socket
This terminal is located at the bottom when the camera is in
an upright position.
Always check the direction of the pins and hold the plug
straight to insert or remove it. (If the cable is inserted in the
wrong direction, the pins could become deformed and cause
faulty operation.)
Also, do not insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause
damage to this unit.
22
SQW0721
Preparations
Charging battery
If the computer enters sleep mode during charging, charging may be stopped.
If a notebook computer that is not connected to an electrical outlet is connected to the camera,
the battery of the notebook computer will be depleted. Do not leave the camera and notebook
connected for a long period of time.
Always connect the USB connection cable to the USB connector on your computer. Do not
connect the USB connection cable to the USB connector of the monitor, keyboard, printer, or USB
hub.
Charging lamp indications
Charging lamp
On: Charging in progress
Off: Charging complete
(After charging stops, disconnect the camera from
the electrical outlet or your computer.)
Flashing: Charging error
(For instructions on correcting the problem,
refer to (→291).)
Notes on charging time
When using the AC adaptor (supplied)
Charging time Approx. 130 min.
• The charging time indicated above is the time required for charging in case when the
battery is completely used up. The time required for charging differs depending on
conditions of battery usage. Charging takes longer in cases when temperatures are
either high or low and when the battery has not been used for a long period of time.
• The time required for charging through the computer varies depending on the power
supply capacity of the computer.
Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one. Doing so may cause
malfunction of the camera.
Do not use any other AC adaptors except the supplied one.
Do not use a USB extension cable.
The AC adaptor (supplied) and the USB connection cable (supplied) are dedicated accessories of
this camera. Do not use them for other devices.
Remove the battery after use. (The battery will be exhausted if left for a long period of time after
being charged.)
If there is any trouble related to the electrical outlet (i.e. power failure), charging may not complete
properly. Disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) and reconnect it to the camera.
If the charging lamp does not light even when the camera is connected to the AC adaptor
(supplied) or a computer, check to make sure it is properly connected. (→21)
23
SQW0721
Preparations
Charging battery
Remaining battery
60
p
Remaining battery (only when using battery)
(flashes red)
If the battery mark flashes red, recharge or replace a fully charged
battery.
Estimated number of recordable pictures and operating time
By CIPA (Camera & Imaging Products Association) standard
When a Panasonic SDHC memory card and the supplied battery are used.
Recording still pictures
Number of recordable pictures Approx. 260 pictures
Recording time Approx. 130 min.
Recording motion pictures
[Rec Format] [AVCHD] [MP4] [MP4]
[Rec Quality] [FHD/17M/60i] [FHD/28M/60p] [4K/100M/30p]
Available recording time Approx. 70 min. Approx. 70 min. Approx. 60 min.
Actual available recording time
*
Approx. 35 min. Approx. 35 min. Approx. 30 min.
*
The time you can actually record when repeatedly turning the camera on and off, starting and
stopping recording and using zoom.
Viewing pictures
Playback time Approx. 170 min.
The operating times and number of recordable pictures will differ according to the
environment and the operating conditions.
For example, in the following cases, the operating times shorten and the number of recordable
pictures is reduced.
In low-temperature environments, such as on ski slopes.
When operations such as the flash and zoom are used repeatedly.
If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan. Please
purchase a new battery.
24
SQW0721
Preparations
Inserting and removing the card (optional)
• Make sure that the camera is turned off.
1
Slide the release lever to the
[OPEN] position and open the
card/battery door
Release lever
2
Insert the card all the way
Do not touch the terminal
• Check the orientation of a card
(terminals face monitor).
• Insert the card all the way firmly until
it clicks.
3
Close the card/battery door
and slide the release lever to
the [LOCK] position
To remove card:
Press the center of
the card.
[OPEN] [LOCK]
Keep the Memory Card out of reach of children to prevent swallowing.
To remove the card, turn the camera off and wait until the LUMIX indicator on the screen goes
off. (Failure to wait may cause the camera to malfunction and may damage the card or recorded
data.)
25
SQW0721
Preparations
About the Card
The following SD standard-based cards can be used.
Type of Card Capacity Notes
SD Memory Cards 512 MB – 2 GB This unit is compatible with UHS-
Ι UHS Speed Class 3
standard SDHC/SDXC memory cards.
Operation of the cards listed on the left has been
confirmed with Panasonic brand card.
SDHC Memory Cards 4 GB – 32 GB
SDXC Memory Cards 48 GB – 128 GB
About motion picture/4K photo recording and speed class ratings
According to the [Rec Format] (→151) and [Rec Quality] (→151) of a motion picture, the
required card differs. To record 4K photos, you need a card with a speed class rating that
supports 4K photo recording. Use a card that meets the following ratings of the SD Speed
Class or UHS Speed Class.
• SD Speed Class and UHS Speed Class are the speed standards regarding continuous
writing. Confirm the SD speed by checking the card label or other card related
materials.
[Rec Format] [Rec Quality] Speed class Label example
[AVCHD] All
Class 4 or higher
[MP4] [FHD]/[HD]
[MP4] [4K]/[High Speed Video] UHS Speed Class 3
When recording in 4K Photo /
[Post Focus]
UHS Speed Class 3
• Latest information:
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This site is available in English only.)
Access to the card
The access indication displays red when pictures are being
recorded on the card.
60
p
While the camera is accessing the card (for an operation such as picture writing, reading, deletion,
or formatting), do not turn off the camera or remove the battery, card, AC adaptor (optional) or DC
coupler (optional). Do not subject the camera to vibrations, impact, or static electricity. The card or
the data on the card may be damaged, and this unit may no longer operate normally. If operation
fails due to vibration, impact or static electricity, perform the operation again.
If you set the write-protect switch to “LOCK”, you may not be able to write, delete
or format the data or display it by recording date.
It is recommended that you copy important pictures to your computer
(as electromagnetic waves, static electricity, or faults may cause data to be
damaged).
26
SQW0721
Preparations
About the Card
Formatting the card (initialization)
Format the card before recording a picture with this unit.
Since data cannot be recovered after formatting, make sure to back up necessary
data in advance.
[Setup] → [Format]
This requires a sufficiently charged battery, or an AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
Do not turn off the camera or perform other operations during formatting.
Always format cards with this camera. Please reformat the card with this camera if it has already
been formatted with a computer or another device.
Estimated recording capacity (number of pictures/recording time)
The number of pictures you can take and the recording time vary in proportion to card
capacity (and depending on recording conditions and type of card).
Recording picture capacity (still pictures)
When [Aspect Ratio] is set to [3:2] and [Quality] is set to [ ]
[Picture Size] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
L (20M) 1450 2910 5810 11510
M (10M)
2650 5310 10510 20810
S (5M)
4600 9220 17640 34940
When [Aspect Ratio] is set to [3:2] and [Quality] is set to [ ]
[Picture Size] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
L (20M) 450 920 1840 3650
M (10M) 530 1070 2140 4250
S (5M) 580 1170 2340 4630
When the number of recordable pictures exceeds 9,999, “9999+” is displayed.
27
SQW0721
Preparations
About the Card
Recording time capacity (motion pictures)
• The recordable time is the total time of all the motion pictures which have been
recorded.
([h], [m] and [s] indicate “hour”, “minute” and “second”.)
When [Rec Format] is [AVCHD]
[Rec Quality] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
[FHD/28M/60p] 1h15m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s 9h55m00s
[FHD/17M/60i] 2h00m00s 4h05m00s 8h15m00s 16h25m00s
[FHD/24M/30p]
[FHD/24M/24p]
1h25m00s 2h55m00s 5h50m00s 11h35m00s
When [Rec Format] is [MP4]
[Rec Quality] 16 GB 32 GB 64 GB 128 GB
[4K/100M/30p]
[4K/100M/24p]
20m00s 42m00s 1h20m00s 2h45m00s
[FHD/28M/60p] 1h10m00s 2h30m00s 5h00m00s 9h55m00s
[FHD/20M/30p] 1h35m00s 3h20m00s 6h40m00s 13h15m00s
[HD/10M/30p] 3h05m00s 6h20m00s 12h45m00s 25h25m00s
[AVCHD] motion pictures:
Files are split into smaller motion picture files for recording when the file size exceeds 4 GB.
Motion pictures with [Rec Quality] setting of [FHD/28M/60p]/[FHD/17M/60i]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
Motion pictures with their file size set to [FHD] or [HD] in [MP4]:
Files are split into smaller motion picture files for recording and playback when the file size
exceeds 4 GB. (You can continue to record motion pictures without interruption.)
Motion pictures with [Rec Quality] setting of [FHD/28M/60p]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
MP4 motion pictures with a [Rec Quality] size of [4K]:
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes.
When using an SDHC memory card, files are split into smaller motion picture files for recording
and playback if the file size exceeds 4 GB. (You can continue to record motion pictures without
interruption.)
If using an SDXC Memory Card, you can record a motion picture in a single file even if the size is
greater than 4 GB.
The maximum available continuous recording time is displayed on the screen.
28
SQW0721
Preparations
Setting the clock
The clock is not set when the camera is shipped.
1
Set the Camera [ON/OFF] switch to [ON]
• If the language select screen is not displayed, proceed
to step
4
.
2
Press [MENU/SET] while the message is displayed
3
Press to select the language, and press [MENU/SET]
• The [Please set the clock] message appears.
4
Press [MENU/SET]
5
Press to select the items (year,
month, day, hour, minute), and press
to set
: Home time
: Destination time
Style
Display order
Time display format
To set the display order or time display format
• Select [Style] and press [MENU/SET] to display the
setting screen for display order and time display
format.
6
Press [MENU/SET]
29
SQW0721
Preparations
Setting the clock
7
When [The clock setting has been completed.] is displayed,
press [MENU/SET]
8
When [Please set the home area] is displayed, press
[MENU/SET]
9
Press to set your home area and
press [MENU/SET]
City or area name
Current time
Difference from GMT (Greenwich Mean Time)
If the clock is not set, the correct date cannot be printed when you order a photo studio to print the
picture, or when you stamp the date on the pictures with [Text Stamp].
Changing time settings
1
Select [Clock Set] from the [Setup] menu
For details about how to set the menu (→42)
2
Set the date and time (Perform steps
5
-
6
. (→28))
Clock settings will be saved for approx. 3 months even after the battery is removed, provided a
fully charged battery was installed in the camera for 24 hours beforehand.
30
SQW0721
Basics
Holding the camera
Hold the camera gently with both hands keeping your arms close to your body
while standing with your feet slightly apart.
To prevent dropping, be sure to attach the supplied strap and fit it to your wrist.
Do not block the flash, AF Assist Lamp, microphone, or speaker with your fingers
or other objects.
• Make sure that the camera does not move at the moment the shutter button is pressed.
• Make sure your footing is stable and there is no danger of colliding with another person
or object in the vicinity while taking pictures.
AF Assist Lamp
Microphone
Flash
Speaker
Hand strap
About the direction detect function
Still pictures recorded with the camera held vertically can be
automatically displayed in portrait orientation during playback.
(Only when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [ON].)
• The direction detect function may not operate correctly if
pictures are taken with the camera pointing up or down.
• Motion pictures, 4K burst files recorded with the 4K Photo
function, and pictures recorded in [Post Focus] cannot be
displayed vertically.
31
SQW0721
Basics
Adjusting the angle of the monitor
You can adjust the angle of the monitor.
Be careful not to catch your finger, etc. in the monitor.
When rotating the angle of the monitor, be careful not to
apply too much force. Doing so may cause damage or
malfunction.
(Open and close with your finger on point
.)
• When not using this camera, close the monitor completely
back to the original position.
Recording from a variety of angles
The monitor can be rotated to suit your needs. This is convenient as it allows you to take
pictures from various angles by adjusting the monitor.
Taking pictures of yourself Taking pictures at low angle
• If you rotate the monitor as shown in the
figure, the camera will switch to Self Shot
Mode. (→57)
32
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Zoom Lever (Use Zoom)
You can adjust the area of a picture to be taken using the zoom lever or control ring.
• You can also use the zoom function from the touch panel. (→143)
• For details about zoom types and use, refer to (→140).
Zoom lever Control ring
1
Move the zoom lever
1
Turn the control ring
*
*
You can perform zoom operation by assigning
the [Zoom] setting to the control ring. (→36)
T side: Telephoto, Enlarge the subject
W side: Wide-angle, Capture a wider area
Clockwise: Telephoto, Enlarge the subject
Counterclockwise: Wide-angle, Capture a wider
area
Do not touch the lens barrel during zooming.
Adjust the focus after adjusting the zoom.
The camera may make a rattling noise and vibrate when the zoom lever or control ring is
operated. This is not a malfunction.
33
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Shutter button (Taking pictures)
• Press the [ ] button ( ) to set the drive mode to [ ] ([Single]).
1
Press the shutter button halfway (press lightly) to
focus on the subject
Focus display
( When focus is aligned: illuminated
When focus is not aligned: flashing)
Aperture value
Shutter speed
The aperture value and shutter speed are displayed. (If the
aperture value and shutter speed are shown in red and flashing,
you do not have the appropriate exposure, unless you are using
the flash.)
2
Press the shutter button fully (push the button all the
way), and take the picture
Pictures can be taken only when the image is correctly focused as long as the [Focus/
Release Priority] (→191) is set to [FOCUS].
When [Live View Mode] (→200) is set to [ECO 30fps], Digital Zoom is not available.
Even during menu operation or picture playback, if you press the shutter button halfway, you can
instantly set the camera ready for recording.
Focus range
Focus range is displayed when operating the zoom
Focus range
• The focus range is displayed in red when it is not focused
after pressing the shutter button halfway.
The focus range may change gradually depending on the zoom position.
34
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Motion picture button (Recording motion pictures)
1
Press the motion picture button to start recording
Immediately release the motion picture button after pressing it.
2
Press the motion picture button again to end recording
Mode dial (Select the recording mode)
1
Set to the desired recording mode
Rotate the mode dial slowly to select the desired mode.
Intelligent Auto Mode (→50)
Intelligent Auto Plus Mode (→50)
Program AE Mode (→61)
Aperture-Priority AE Mode (→62)
Shutter-Priority AE Mode (→63)
Manual Exposure Mode (→64)
Creative Video Mode (→82)
Custom Mode (→85)
Panorama Shot Mode (→69)
Scene Guide Mode (→72)
Creative Control Mode (→76)
35
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Control ring / Aperture ring / Rear dial
You can use the control ring ( )/Aperture ring ( )/rear dial ( ) to change the settings of
the unit.
• You can adjust the aperture using the aperture ring. Gently turn the aperture ring until it
snaps into place with an audible click. (The aperture can be set between [1.4] and [11].)
(→62, 64, 82)
• Items that can be set by the control ring/rear dial vary depending on recording modes.
Following are the pre-assigned settings.
Mode dial
(→34)
Control ring
*
1
Rear dial
Step Zoom (→196)
Step Zoom
Program Shift (→61)
Step Zoom
Step Zoom
Shutter speed adjustment (→63)
Step Zoom
Shutter speed adjustment
Step Zoom
Shutter speed adjustment
*
2
Picture effects change
Step Zoom
Shutter speed adjustment
*
3
Picture effects change (→76)
*
1
When Manual Focus is set, the control ring is assigned to focus adjustment. (→100)
*
2
The operation is possible only when [Exposure Mode] is set to [S] or [M]. (→82)
*
3
The operation is possible only when the Scene Guide Mode is set to [Artistic Nightscape].
• You can assign your preferred settings to the control dial/rear dial. (→36)
36
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Changing the settings assigned to the control ring/rear dial
Changes the settings assigned to the control ring/rear dial.
[Custom] → [Ring/Dial Set]
→ [ ] ([Control Ring Operation]) or [ ] ([Rear Dial Operation])
[DEFLT] [Normal] [Photo Style] (→170)
[Zoom]
*
(→140)
[Filter Effect] (→172)
[Step Zoom]
*
(→196)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)
[Exposure Comp.] (→103) [Highlight Shadow] (→176)
[Sensitivity] (→104) [i.Dynamic] (→177)
[White Balance] (→106) [i.Resolution] (→177)
[AF Mode] (→89) [Flash Mode] (→146)
[Focus Mode] (→87, 99, 100) [Flash Adjust.] (→148)
[Drive Mode] (→126)
[OFF] [Not Set]
*
*
Items that can only be set to the control ring
To return to the default setting, select [Normal].
If you do not use the control ring, select [Not Set].
Under [Highlight Shadow], use the control ring and rear dial.
If [Highlight Shadow] is assigned to the control ring (or rear dial), [Highlight Shadow] will also be
assigned to the rear dial (or control ring).
The assigned function setting applies to all the recording modes.
However, the assigned function may not operate when combined with certain recording mode.
37
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Cursor button / [MENU/SET] button (Selecting/setting items)
Pressing the cursor button: Selection of items or setting of values etc., is
performed.
Pressing [MENU/SET]: Confirmation of setting contents, etc., is performed.
• In this manual, the button that is to be used is indicated by
.
• When the [Cursor Button Lock] is assigned to the function
button, operation of the cursor button and [MENU/SET]
button can be disabled. (→46, 47)
[DISP.] button (Switching the display information)
1
Press [DISP.] button to switch the display
If the information on the screen is not displayed any longer
because no operation was performed for some time, press the
[DISP.] button or touch the screen to display the information
again.
During recording
With information Without information
With information
+
level gauge
Without information
+
level gauge
60
p
60
p
38
SQW0721
Basics
Buttons/Dials/Levers Used for Recording
Using the level gauge
If you want to make sure that the camera is not slanted or tilted, for example, when you
take a picture of a landscape, use the level gauge indication as a reference.
The yellow line indicates the current angle. Correct the angle of the camera so that it
matches the white line.
Tilting up or down
In this case, it is facing upward.
Tilting left or right
In this case, the right side has
dropped.
• When the camera is tilted very little or not at all, the level gauge will turn green.
Even when angle is more or less corrected, there may be an error of about ±1 degree.
The level gauge may not be displayed correctly or the direction detect function (→30) may not
operate correctly if the pictures are taken with the camera pointing sharply up or down.
During playback
With information
Detailed information
display Histogram display
Without information
([Highlight])
*
100-0001
AM10:00 DEC. 1.2016
100-00011/98
R
G
B
Y
Without information
*
This screen is displayed only when [Highlight] (→194) in the [Custom] menu is set to [ON].
Some screens cannot be displayed during playback of certain files, for example motion picture
and 4K burst files.
39
SQW0721
Basics
Touch screen (Touch operations)
Touch screen of this unit is capacitive. Touch the panel directly with your bare finger.
Touch
To touch and release the touch screen.
Drag
To touch and slide your finger across the touch screen.
Pinch (spread/pinch)
On the touch screen, spread (pinch out) your 2 fingers to
zoom in, and pinch (pinch in) your 2 fingers to zoom out.
Touch the screen with the clean and dry finger.
If you use a commercially available monitor protection sheet, please follow the instructions that
accompany the sheet. (Some monitor protection sheets may impair visibility or operability.)
The touch screen may not function normally in the following cases.
When touched by a gloved hand
When the touch screen is wet
40
SQW0721
Basics
Touch screen (Touch operations)
Touching the screen and recording (Touch Shutter function)
Recording mode:
This function enables you to focus and record still pictures simply by touching the
subjects that appear on the screen.
1
Touch [ ]
2
Touch [ ]
The icon changes to [ ] and you can now proceed with touch
shutter recording.
3
Touch the subject you want to record
To release the touch shutter function
Touch [
]
If shooting with the touch shutter fails, the AF area turns red and disappears.
41
SQW0721
Basics
Touch screen (Touch operations)
Easily Optimizing the Brightness for a Specified Area
([Touch AE])
Recording mode:
You can easily optimize the brightness for a touched position. When the face of the
subject appears dark, you can brighten the screen according to the brightness of the face.
1
Touch [ ]
2
Touch [ ]
The setting screen for the brightness optimization position is
displayed.
[Metering Mode] is set to [
], which is used exclusively for the
[Touch AE].
3
Touch the subject you want to optimize the brightness
for
Touching [Reset] will bring the brightness optimization position
back to the center.
SetSet
Reset
Reset
4
Touch [Set]
Canceling the [Touch AE] function
Touch [
]
[Metering Mode] returns to the original setting, and the brightness optimization position is canceled.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
When using the Digital Zoom
When [High Speed Video] is set
When [4K Live Cropping] is set
When [Touch AF] in [Touch Settings] of the [Custom] menu has been set to [AF+AE] (→98)
42
SQW0721
Basics
Setting the menu
You can use the menu to set camera and recording functions, operate playback functions,
and perform other operations.
• Menu settings can be made either by button or touch operation.
1
Press [MENU/SET] to bring up the menu
[Rec]
(→169)
You can perform settings for the aspect ratio, number of pixels, 4K
Photo, etc.
[Motion Picture]
(→187)
You can select the recording format and picture quality and other
settings.
[Custom]
(→189)
Operation of the unit, such as displaying of the screen and button
operations, can be set up according to your preferences.
[Setup]
(→198)
You can perform settings that make usage more convenient, such
as the changing the clock settings and beep volume. You can also
perform Wi-Fi function-related settings.
[Playback]
(→207)
You can specify picture protection, cropping, print settings, and
other settings for pictures you have taken.
Switching menu type
Menu type
Press
Press to select a tab such as [ ]
Items can also be selected by rotating the rear dial.
Press [MENU/SET]
With touch screen operations
Touch a tab, such as [
]
43
SQW0721
Basics
Setting the menu
2
Press to select the menu item and
press [MENU/SET]
Item
Page
• The menu item can also be selected by rotating the
rear dial.
• You can also switch to the next page by pressing
[DISP.] button or rotating the zoom lever.
With touch screen operations
Touch the menu item
You can switch to the next page by touching [ ]/[ ].
3
Press to select the setting and press
[MENU/SET]
Selected setting
Settings
• The setting can also be selected by rotating the rear
dial.
• The setting methods vary depending on the menu
item.
With touch screen operations
Touch the setting to set
4
Press [Q.MENU/ ] button repeatedly
until the recording or playback screen
reappears
• During recording, the menu screen can also be exited
by pressing the shutter button halfway.
With touch screen operations
Touch [
]
44
SQW0721
Basics
Calling frequently-used menus instantly
(Quick Menu)
You can easily call some of the menu items and set them during recording.
• Some items or settings can not be selected depending on the mode or display style the
camera is in.
1
Press [Q.MENU/ ] button
• You can also use the button as a function button.
(→46)
2
Press to select a menu item, and
press or
• The menu item can also be selected by rotating the
rear dial.
60
p
60
p
3
Press to select the setting
• The setting can also be selected by rotating the rear
dial.
60
p
60
p
4
Press [Q.MENU/ ] button to close the Quick menu
45
SQW0721
Basics
Calling frequently-used menus instantly (Quick Menu)
Change the Quick Menu to your preferred item
When [Q.MENU] (→197) in the [Custom] menu is set to [CUSTOM], the Quick Menu can
be changed as desired. Up to 15 items can be set to the Quick Menu.
1
After pressing the [Q.MENU/ ] button, press to
select [ ], and press [MENU/SET]
2
Press to select the menu item in the top row
and press [MENU/SET]
Top row: Items that can be set
Bottom row: Set items
Items that are displayed in gray in the top row have already been
set.
3
Press to select the empty space in the bottom row
and press [MENU/SET]
You can also set the menu item by dragging it from the top row to
the bottom row.
If there is no empty space in the bottom row, you can replace an
existing item with a new select item by selecting the existing item.
To cancel the setting, move to the bottom row by pressing
and
select an item to cancel, and then press [MENU/SET].
4
Press [Q.MENU/ ] button
It will return to screen of step
1
. Press [MENU/SET] to switch to the recording screen.
46
SQW0721
Basics
You can assign frequently-used functions to particular buttons ([Fn1] - [Fn3]) or icons
displayed on the screen ([Fn4] - [Fn8]).
• Certain functions cannot be assigned to some function buttons.
• The function assigned to the function button may not work in some modes or on some
display screens.
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Custom] → [Fn Button Set]
Settings: [Setting in REC mode] / [Setting in PLAY mode]
2
Press to select the function button
you want to assign a function to and
press [MENU/SET]
3
Press to select the function you want to assign and press
[MENU/SET]
• For details on the functions that can be assigned in [Setting in REC mode], refer
to (→47).
• For details on the functions that can be assigned in [Setting in PLAY mode], refer
to (→48).
Rapidly assigning functions
The assignment screen displayed in Step
3
above can be displayed by holding a function
button ([Fn1] to [Fn3]) for 2 seconds.
• In some cases the function assignment screen cannot be displayed depending on the
mode or display screen.
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons
(Function buttons)
47
SQW0721
Basics
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons)
Using the function buttons during recording
Press the function button to use the assigned function.
Using function buttons with touch operations
Touch [ ]
Touch [Fn4], [Fn5], [Fn6], [Fn7] or [Fn8]
Functions that can be assigned in [Setting in REC mode]
[Rec] menu/Recording functions
[4K Photo Mode] (→110): [Fn1]
*
[Post Focus] (→121): [Fn2]
*
[Wi-Fi] (→228): [Fn4]
*
[Q.MENU] (→44): [Fn3]
*
[AF/AE LOCK] (→102)
[AF-ON] (→102)
[Preview] (→66)
[One Push AE] (→68)
[Touch AE] (→41)
[Level Gauge] (→38): [Fn5]
*
[Cursor Button Lock]
[Photo Style] (→170)
[Filter Effect] (→172)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)
[Picture Size] (→174)
[Quality] (→174)
[Sensitivity] (→104)
[AF Mode] (→89)
[AFS/AFF/AFC] (→88)
[Metering Mode] (→175)
[Bracket] (→130)
[Highlight Shadow] (→176)
[i.Dynamic] (→177)
[i.Resolution] (→177)
[HDR] (→178)
[Shutter Type] (→180)
[Flash Mode] (→146)
[Flash Adjust.] (→148)
[i.Zoom] (→141)
[Digital Zoom] (→142)
[Stabilizer] (→138)
[Restore to Default]
[Motion Picture] menu
[4K Live Cropping] (→154)
[Snap Movie] (→158): [Fn7]
*
[Rec Format] / [Rec Quality] (→151)
[Custom] menu
[Silent Mode] (→189)
[Peaking] (→192)
[Histogram] (→193): [Fn6]
*
[Guide Line] (→193)
[Zebra Pattern] (→194)
[Monochrome Live View] (→195)
[Rec Area] (→196)
[Zoom lever] (→196)
[Touch Screen] (→197)
*
Function button settings at the time of purchase.
([Fn8] has no function button setting at the time of purchase)
48
SQW0721
Basics
Assigning frequently used functions to the buttons (Function buttons)
When [Cursor Button Lock] is assigned to a function button, operation of the cursor button and
[MENU/SET] is disabled. To enable operation, press the function button again.
If the screen displays or similar, the displayed operation will be
performed instead of the function assigned to function buttons by
[Fn Button Set].
Using the function buttons during playback
You can directly set an assigned function to a selected image by pressing the function
button during playback.
Example: When [Fn2] is set to [Favorite]
1
Press to select the picture
2
Press [Fn2] button, and then set the picture as
[Favorite]
Functions that can be assigned in [Setting in PLAY mode]
• The following functions can be assigned to the button [Fn1] or [Fn2].
[Playback] menu/Playback functions
[Wi-Fi] (→228): [Fn1]
*
[Favorite] (→223): [Fn2]
*
[Print Set] (→224)
[Protect] (→225)
[Delete Single] (→168)
[Off]
[Restore to Default]
*
Function button settings at the time of purchase.
49
SQW0721
Basics
Entering Text
1
Use to select characters
2
Press [MENU/SET] several times until the
desired character is displayed
• [ ]: Enter a blank.
To change the character type
• Press [DISP.] button
• Use
to select [ ] and press [MENU/SET]
To continue entering characters
• Use
to select [ ] and press [MENU/SET]
• Move the zoom lever toward T side
• Rotate the rear dial counterclockwise.
To edit text
Use to select [ ] [ ] and press [MENU/SET]. Then, move the cursor
to the text to edit
You can also use the zoom lever or rear dial to reposition the cursor.
Use to select [Delete] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select the correct text, and press [MENU/SET]
3
When you are finished entering text, use to select
[Set] and press [MENU/SET]
A maximum of 30 characters can be entered (maximum of 9 characters when setting names in
[Face Recog.]).
A maximum of 15 characters can be entered for [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ] and [ ] (maximum of
6 characters when setting names in [Face Recog.]).
50
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings
(Intelligent Auto Mode)
Recording mode:
This mode is recommended for those who want to point and shoot as the camera
optimizes settings to match the subject and recording environment.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
The camera will switch to either the most recently used
of Intelligent Auto Mode or Intelligent Auto Plus Mode.
At the time of purchase, the mode is set to Intelligent
Auto Plus Mode.
2
Point the camera at the subject
• When the camera identifies the optimal scene, the
icon for each scene turns blue for 2 seconds and then
changes to the normal red indication.
(Automatic Scene Detection)
60
p
Switching between Intelligent Auto Plus Mode and Intelligent Auto Mode
Select the [
] or [ ] tab on the menu screen, press to
select [ ] or [ ], and press [MENU/SET].
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the Recording
mode icon in recording screen.
60
p
(○: Available, –: Not available)
Intelligent Auto Plus Mode
Intelligent Auto Mode
Defocus control
function
Setting the brightness
(exposure)
Setting the color tone
Menus that can be set Many Few
51
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Auto Focus, Face/Eye Detection, and Face Recognition
[AF Mode] is automatically set to [ ]. If you touch the subject, the camera switches to
[ ] and the AF tracking function starts operating.
You can also switch to [ ] by pressing [MENU/SET], going to the [Rec] menu, then
going to the [AF Mode] menu and selecting [ ] (tracking). Align the AF tracking area with
the subject and press the shutter button halfway to operate the AF tracking function.
For details about AF tracking, refer to (→91).
• When [Face Recog.] (→183) is set to [ON] and if the camera recognizes a face similar
to a registered face, [R] is displayed on the upper right corner of the [ ], [ ], and
[ ] icons.
Flash
When the flash is open, the camera automatically sets [ ], [ ] (Auto/Red-Eye
Reduction), [ ], or [ ] based on the type of subject and brightness.
When [ ] or [ ] is displayed, the [Red-Eye Removal] function is activated to automatically
detect red-eye and correct the picture data.
When [ ] or [ ] is selected, the shutter speed is reduced.
52
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Automatic Scene Detection
When taking pictures
[i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Macro]
[i-Night Portrait]
*
1
[i-Night Scenery]
[i-Handheld Night
Shot]
*
2
[i-Food]
[i-Baby]
*
3
[i-Sunset] When scene does not correspond to any of the above
*
1
Displayed only when using flash.
*
2
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is [ON]. (→53)
*
3
When children (that are registered in the camera with Face Recognition) under 3 years old are
recognized.
• When the camera identifies [ ] as the optimal scene and if the camera determines
that jitter is reduced by the use of a tripod or by other means, a shutter speed that
is slower than usual is selected. After pressing the shutter button, do not move the
camera while recording.
• When recording 4K photos or when recording using [Post Focus], Scene Detection
works the same way as when recording motion pictures.
When recording motion pictures
[i-Portrait] [i-Scenery] [i-Low Light] [i-Macro]
When scene does not correspond to any of the above
Depending on recording conditions, different scene types may be determined for the same
subject.
About Backlight Compensation
Backlight compensation is automatically activated in Intelligent Auto Plus Mode or Intelligent Auto
Mode. Backlight is a condition where a light shines from behind a subject. When there is a backlight,
the subject appears darker and the camera will automatically attempt to correct it by increasing the
brightness of the picture.
53
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Taking pictures using a handheld camera
([iHandheld Night Shot])
Recording mode:
If a night scene is detected automatically while the unit is being handheld, [iHandheld
Night Shot] can record a still picture with less jitter and less noise without using a tripod
by combining a burst of pictures.
[Rec] → [iHandheld Night Shot]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
The angle of view becomes narrow slightly.
After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
The flash is fixed to the [ ] (Forced Flash Off) setting.
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
This function is not available in the following cases:
When using [Burst]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording using [Bracket]
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
54
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Combining pictures into a single still picture with rich
gradation ([iHDR])
Recording mode:
When there is, for example, strong contrast between the background and the subject,
[iHDR] records multiple still pictures with differing exposures and combines them to
create a single still picture rich in gradation.
[iHDR] is activated when required. When activated, [ ] will be displayed on the screen.
[Rec] → [iHDR]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
The angle of view becomes narrow slightly.
After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few
moments before you can record another picture.
In the case of composition from a burst, afterimages may appear if the subject was moving.
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
This function is not available in the following cases:
When recording using the flash
When using [Burst]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording using [Bracket]
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
55
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Recording images by changing the brightness (exposure) or
color tone
Recording mode:
Setting brightness (exposure)
1
Press to display the setting screen
Each press of [Fn1] switches between defocus control operation (→56) and operation finish.
2
Rotate the rear dial to adjust brightness (exposure)
Press in the brightness setting screen to set the exposure
bracket. (→131)
OFF
Setting coloring
1
Press to display the setting screen
2
Rotate the rear dial to adjust color
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
With touch screen operations
Touch [ ]
Touch the item you want to set
[ ]: Coloring
[ ]: Brightness (exposure)
Drag the slide bar to set
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
The color setting will return to the default level (center point) when this unit is turned off or the
camera is switched to another Recording mode.
56
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures with automatic settings (Intelligent Auto Mode)
Defocusing the background (Defocus control function)
Recording mode:
1
After pressing in step
1
of “Setting brightness (exposure)” (→55), press the
[Fn1] button to display the setting screen
2
Rotate the rear dial to adjust the background defocusing condition
250 125 60 30 15
8.05.62.8 4.02.0
Strong defocusing Slight defocusing
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
With touch screen operations
Touch [ ]
Touch [ ] to display the setting screen
Drag the exposure meter to set the blurriness
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
Pressing [Q.MENU/ ] button on the blurriness setting screen will cancel the setting.
Auto Focus Mode is set to [ ]. The position of the AF area can be set by touching the screen.
(Its size cannot be changed)
57
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures of Yourself
[Self Shot]
Recording mode:
If you rotate the monitor, Self Shot Mode is activated. You can easily take pictures of
yourself while looking at the screen.
In Self Shot Mode...
Deciding on a composition is easier because recording is
performed while looking at the screen.
Pictures with different poses and facial expressions can be
taken at once by increasing the number of pictures to be
recorded.
Automatically enables the touch operation.
Settings for the respective Recording Modes are maintained,
except for the recording settings for Self Shot Mode.
1
Rotate the monitor as shown in the figure
• When you rotate the monitor, a mirror image will be
displayed on the monitor.
2
Touch the item
([Soft Skin])
Makes people’s faces look brighter and their skin tones look
softer.
([Filter Select]) Add a picture effect (filter) appropriate to [Self Shot].
([Slimming Mode]) Makes people look slimmer.
([Shutter]) Sets the way the shutter is released.
([Countdown])/
([Shots])
Set the number of seconds before recording ([Countdown]) and
the number of consecutive shots ([Shots]).
58
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures of Yourself [Self Shot]
3
Touch the slide bar
• You can set it to “Off” or a value in the range [1] to
[10]. If you select the left edge of the slide bar ( ), it
will be set to “Off”.
• In the case of [Filter Select], [Shutter], or [Shots],
select from the icons.
ExitExit
[Filter Select]
[
] (No effect), [ ] (Expressive), [ ] (Retro), [ ] (High key),
[
] (Toy effect), [ ] (Soft focus)
[Shutter]
[
] (Shutter button only), [ ] (Touch), [ ] (Buddy), [ ] (Face)
[Shots]
[
] (1 pic.), [ ] (2 pic.), [ ] (3 pic.), [ ] (4 pic.)
4
Touch [Exit]
5
Decide on your poses while looking at the monitor
• The AF area is displayed around the subject’s face by the Face/Eye Detection
function. (If [ ] in AF Mode is not available with the current Recording Mode, an
available focus setting for each Recording Mode will be used.)
6
Press the shutter button halfway to focus
and then press it fully to take the picture
Look at the lens when recording.
• Countdown starts, and recording takes place when it
ends.
If multiple pictures are set to be recorded, the
recording continues until the set number is reached.
• For information on how to start taking a picture using
[Shutter], refer to (→59).
59
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures of Yourself [Self Shot]
Changing the way the shutter is released
In [Shutter], you can select the way you start recording without pressing the shutter
button.
We recommend that you avoid using the shutter button when, for example, jitter occurs
during shutter operation.
Face Shutter
The shutter is released when a face detected by the Face/Eye Detection function is
covered with a hand or other object and then detected again.
1
Display the yellow frame of Face/Eye Detection
2
Cover your face with your hand or other object so that the yellow frame
disappears for a moment
3
When you move your hand away and the yellow frame appears, the shutter is
released
Buddy Shutter
The shutter is released when two faces detected by the Face/Eye Detection function
move closer to each other.
1
Display two Face/Eye Detection frames
When [ ] (Buddy) is selected, even if several subjects are present, Face/Eye Detection detects
only a maximum of two faces.
2
The shutter is released when the two frames come within a certain distance of
each other
60
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures of Yourself [Self Shot]
If you set [Self Shot] to [OFF], the mode will not switch to Self Shot Mode even if you rotate the
monitor.
Be careful not to look at the light from the flash and the AF Assist Lamp directly.
When the [Soft Skin] is set
If you set the strength of the effect to [2] or greater, the recording screen display will be more
delayed than normal like a frame dropping.
When you record with the strength of the effect set to [2] or greater, it will require some time to
process the image before the next shot.
The smoothing effect is applied to the part that has a similar tone to the complexion of a subject,
as well.
This mode may not be effective under insufficient lighting.
This function is not available in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
[Soft Skin] is not available in the following cases:
[Glistening Water], [Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape],
[Artistic Nightscape], [Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld Night Shot], [Soft Image of a Flower],
[Appetizing Food], [Cute Dessert] (Scene Guide Mode)
Creative Control Mode
In Manual Focus
You can start recording with the shutter button regardless of the [Shutter] setting.
When using [
] (Shutter button only), only the shutter button can be used.
For information on [ ] (Touch), refer to (→40).
[ ] (Buddy) and [ ] (Face) are not available in the following cases:
Recording Modes which do not allow setting to [
] of AF Mode (→90)
In Manual Focus
61
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures after automatically setting the
aperture value and shutter speed
(Program AE Mode)
Recording mode:
Take pictures using automatic aperture values and shutter speed settings in accordance
with the brightness of a subject.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Press the shutter button halfway
• If the aperture value and shutter speed flash red, you do not have the correct
exposure.
3
While the numeric values are displayed
(approximately 10 seconds), rotate the
rear dial to change the values using
Program Shift
Program Shift indication
Aperture value
Shutter speed
60
p
250 125 60 30 15
5.64.02.01.4 2.8
• To cancel Program Shift, either turn off the camera or rotate the rear dial until the
Program Shift indication turns off.
• Program Shift can easily be canceled by setting a function button to [One Push
AE]. (→68)
About Program Shift
The function for maintaining the same exposure (brightness) while changing the aperture
value and shutter speed combination is called “Program Shift”. You can use “Program
Shift” to take pictures by adjusting the aperture value and shutter speed even in Program
AE Mode.
Program Shift cannot be used in the following cases:
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When ISO sensitivity is set to [
]
62
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording mode:
• The effect of the aperture value and shutter speed you have set is not applied to the
recording screen. To check the effect on the recording screen, use Preview Mode.
(→66)
• The brightness of the screen may vary from the actual pictures recorded. Check the
brightness of pictures using the playback screen.
• When you adjust the aperture value and shutter speed, an exposure meter is displayed.
If the correct exposure is not achieved, the numeric values of the aperture are shown in
red.
• If the correct exposure is not achieved when you press the shutter button halfway, the
numeric values of the aperture and shutter speed are displayed in flashing red.
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value
(Aperture-Priority AE Mode)
When the aperture value is increased, the range of depth in focus expands, and the
picture shows up clearly from the position of the camera to the background. When the
aperture value is reduced, the range of depth in focus shrinks, and the background can
get blurry.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Rotate the aperture ring to set the aperture value
Aperture value
Exposure meter
Aperture values
that can be set
*
Shutter speed set (seconds)
F1.4 - F11
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
*
You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom
position.
250 125 60 30 15
8.0 15.62.82.0 4.0
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and
shutter speed
63
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures by setting the shutter speed
(Shutter-Priority AE Mode)
When you increase the shutter speed, you can reduce jitter when recording a subject.
When you decrease the shutter speed, the subject’s movement is shown.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Rotate the rear dial to set the shutter speed
Shutter speed
Exposure meter
Shutter speeds that can be set (seconds)
Aperture value
set
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
F1.4 - F11
4 8 15 30 60
5.6 4.0 2.8 2.11 8.0
If you switch the recording mode to Shutter-Priority AE Mode when ISO sensitivity is set to [ ],
ISO sensitivity will change to [AUTO].
64
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
(Manual Exposure Mode)
Determine the exposure by manually setting the aperture value and the shutter speed.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Rotate the aperture ring to select the aperture value
Aperture value
Shutter speed
Manual Exposure Assist
Exposure meter
15 30 60 125 250
8.0 115.62.80 4.0
3
Rotate the rear dial to set the shutter speed
Aperture values that
can be set
*
1
Shutter speeds that can be set
(seconds)
*
2
F1.4 - F11
T (Time),
60 - 1/4000
(When the mechanical shutter is used)
1 - 1/16000
(When the electronic shutter is used)
*
1
You may not be able to select some values depending on zoom
position.
*
2
You may not be able to select some shutter speeds depending
on the aperture value.
If you switch the recording mode to Manual Exposure Mode when ISO sensitivity is set to [ ],
ISO sensitivity will change to [AUTO].
65
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Optimizing the ISO sensitivity for the aperture value and shutter speed
When the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO], the camera sets the ISO sensitivity automatically so that the
exposure will be appropriate for the aperture value and shutter speed.
Depending on recording conditions, an appropriate exposure may not be set or the ISO sensitivity
may become higher.
Manual exposure assist (estimate)
Shows pictures with standard brightness (appropriate exposure).
Shows brighter pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a faster shutter
speed or increase aperture value.
Shows darker pictures. For the appropriate exposure, either use a slower shutter
speed or reduce aperture value.
About [T] (Time)
If you set the shutter speed to [T], the shutter stays open when the shutter button is
pressed fully. (Approximately up to 120 seconds)
The shutter closes if you press the shutter button again. Use this function when you
want to keep the shutter open for an extended period, for example, to record pictures of
fireworks or night scenes.
• When ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO], ISO sensitivity will change to [125].
When taking pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), we recommend using a tripod
and taking pictures remotely by connecting the camera to a smartphone to prevent camera
shake. (→236)
When you take still pictures with the shutter speed set to T (time), the pictures may have
higher noise levels. If you want to suppress noise, we recommend taking pictures by setting
[Long Shtr NR] to [ON] in the [Rec] menu. (→182)
This function is not available in the following cases:
When recording using the flash (Only when [Flash Synchro] is set to [2ND])
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording using [Bracket]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When using the electronic shutter
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
66
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Checking the effects of the aperture value and shutter speed
(Preview Mode)
Recording mode:
You can use Preview Mode to check the effects of the selected aperture value and shutter
speed.
Checking the effect of the selected aperture value: This enables you to check the
depth of field (focus range) by physically narrowing the lens aperture blades to the
aperture value used for the actual recording.
Checking the effect of the selected shutter speed: This allows you to check motion
in a scene by displaying the screen at the shutter speed used for the actual recording.
1
Assign [Preview] to the function button (→46)
The following step is an example of assigning [Preview] to the [Fn3] button.
2
Press the [Fn3] button to switch the confirmation screen
Every time you press the [Fn3] button, the screen switches.
Normal recording screen
Aperture effect preview
screen
Effect of aperture value: ○
Effect of shutter speed: –
Shutter speed effect
preview screen
Effect of aperture value: ○
Effect of shutter speed: ○
Fn3
Shtr Speed Effect added.
Fn3
Preview completed.
67
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Depth of field characteristic
Recording
conditions
Aperture value Small Large
Focal length Telephoto Wide-angle
Distance to a subject Close Far
Depth of field
(Focus range)
Shallow (narrow)
Example:
To take a picture by
deliberately blurring the
background
Deep (wide)
Example:
To take a picture by adjusting
the focus while including the
background
You can take a picture even when Preview Mode is activated.
The range in which you can check the effect of a selected shutter speed is between 8 seconds
and 1/16000 seconds.
This mode cannot be used with [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of 4K Photo.
68
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures by setting the aperture value and shutter speed
Easily set aperture / shutter speed for suitable exposure
(One Push AE)
Recording mode:
When the exposure setting is too bright or too dark, you can use one push AE to achieve
a suitable exposure setting.
How to tell if the exposure is not adequate
If the aperture values and shutter speed blink red when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
Blinks red
1
Assign [One Push AE] to the function button (→46)
2
(When exposure is not adequate) Press the function button
Exposure meter
Change to appropriate exposure
1
000
1.42.02.8
250 500 2
000
4
000
The exposure meter is not displayed in Creative Video Mode.
In the following cases, suitable exposure cannot be set.
When the subject is extremely dark and it is not possible to achieve adequate exposure by
changing the aperture value or shutter speed
When recording using the flash
Preview Mode (→66)
When [Exposure Mode] is set to [P], [A], or [M] in Creative Control Mode
69
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording mode:
Consecutive photos taken while the camera is moved are combined to form a panorama.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Press the shutter button halfway to focus
3
Press the shutter button fully and pan the camera in a small
circular motion to the recording direction to start recording
Horizontal/vertical guide line
Recording direction and progress status (approximate)
Taking pictures from left to right
Image size: [STANDARD] Image size: [WIDE]
Pan the camera at a constant speed.
You may not be able to take pictures successfully if you move the camera too quickly or too
slowly.
4
Press the shutter button fully again to end recording
• You can also end recording if you stop panning the camera while taking pictures.
• Recording can also be ended by moving the camera to the end of the guide.
Recording panorama pictures
(Panorama Shot Mode)
70
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording panorama pictures (Panorama Shot Mode)
Changing the recording direction and angle of view (image size) of panorama
pictures
[Rec] → [Panorama Settings]
[Direction] Sets the recording direction.
[Picture Size] Sets the angle of view (image size).
[STANDARD] / [WIDE]
• The number of recording pixels per horizontal line and vertical line of a panorama
picture varies depending on the picture size, recording direction and number of stitched
pictures. The maximum number of recording pixels is as follows:
Image size Recording direction Horizontal Resolution Vertical Resolution
[STANDARD]
Horizontal 8176 pixels 1920 pixels
Vertical 2560 pixels 7680 pixels
[WIDE]
Horizontal 8176 pixels 960 pixels
Vertical 1280 pixels 7680 pixels
Tips
Pan the camera in the recording direction as steadily as possible.
(If the camera shakes too much, it may not be able to take pictures or may end up creating a narrow
(small) panorama picture.)
Pan the camera to a point slightly ahead of the
point that you want to take.
(However, the last frame is not recorded to the
end.)
71
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording panorama pictures (Panorama Shot Mode)
About panorama picture playback
Pressing
will start scrolling playback automatically in the
same direction as the recording.
• The following operations can be performed during scrolling
playback.
Start panorama playback / Pause
*
Stop
*
When the playback is paused, you can scroll forwards and backwards by dragging the screen. When
the scroll bar is touched, the playback position jumps to the touched position.
The zoom position is fixed to the W end.
The focus, exposure and White Balance are all fixed to optimal values for the first picture.
If the focusing or brightness of pictures recorded as part of a panorama picture after the first
picture are significantly different from those of the first picture, the panorama picture as a whole
(when all pictures are stitched together) may not have consistent focus and brightness.
Since several pictures are stitched together to create a panorama picture, some subjects may be
distorted or the joining portions of successively taken pictures that are stitched may be noticeable.
[Shutter Type] is fixed to [ESHTR].
Panorama pictures may not be created or pictures may not be recorded properly when taking
pictures of the following subjects or when taking pictures in the following recording conditions:
Subjects that have a continuous monotone or pattern (sky, beach, etc.)
Moving subjects (person, pet, vehicle, waves, or flowers swaying in the wind, etc.)
Subjects whose colors or patterns change quickly (such as an image appearing on a display)
Dark locations
Locations with a flickering light source (fluorescent lamp, candle light, etc.)
72
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording mode:
If you select a scene to suit the subject and recording conditions with reference to the
example images, the camera will set optimal exposure, color, and focus, allowing you to
record in a manner appropriate to the scene.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Press to select the scene
• The scene can also be selected by dragging an
example image or the slide bar.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the Recording
mode icon in recording screen.
60
p
8
Depending on the scene, the recording screen may seem as if frames are missed.
To change the Scene Guide Mode, select the [ ] tab on the menu screen, select [Scene
Switch], and then press [MENU/SET]. You can return to step
2
.
The following items cannot be set in Scene Guide Mode because the camera automatically
adjusts them to the optimal setting.
Items other than the picture quality adjustment in [Photo Style], [Sensitivity], [Filter Settings],
[Metering Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [HDR] and [Multi Exp.]
Although White Balance is fixed to [AWB] for certain types of scene, you can fine tune the White
Balance or use White Balance bracketing by pressing the cursor button
on the recording
screen. (→108, 109)
Taking pictures according to the scene
(Scene Guide Mode)
73
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures according to the scene (Scene Guide Mode)
Types of Scene Guide Mode
Displaying the description of each scene and recording tips
Press [DISP.] button while the scene selection screen is displayed
When it is set to the guide display, detailed explanations and tips for each scene are displayed.
Normal display Guide display List display
1: [Clear Portrait]
2: [Silky Skin]
If a part of the background etc. is a color close to skin color, this part is also smoothed.
This mode may not be effective when there is insufficient brightness.
3: [Backlit Softness]
4: [Clear in Backlight]
Open the flash.
5: [Relaxing Tone]
6: [Sweet Child’s Face]
When you touch the face, a still picture is recorded with the focus and exposure set for the touched
location.
7: [Distinct Scenery]
74
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures according to the scene (Scene Guide Mode)
8: [Bright Blue Sky]
9: [Romantic Sunset Glow]
10: [Vivid Sunset Glow]
11: [Glistening Water]
Star filter used in this mode may cause glistening effects on the objects other than water surface.
12: [Clear Nightscape]
13: [Cool Night Sky]
14: [Warm Glowing Nightscape]
15: [Artistic Nightscape]
16: [Glittering Illuminations]
17: [Handheld Night Shot]
After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
The angle of view becomes narrow slightly.
18: [Clear Night Portrait]
Open the flash.
Tripod, self-timer recommended.
When [Clear Night Portrait] is selected, keep the subject still for about 1 second after taking the
picture.
19: [Soft Image of a Flower]
For close-up recording, we recommend that you avoid using the flash.
75
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking pictures according to the scene (Scene Guide Mode)
20: [Appetizing Food]
Degree of background defocusing can be changed by adjusting the aperture using the aperture ring.
For close-up recording, we recommend that you avoid using the flash.
21: [Cute Dessert]
For close-up recording, we recommend that you avoid using the flash.
22: [Freeze Animal Motion]
Default [AF Assist Lamp] setting is [OFF].
23: [Clear Sports Shot]
24: [Monochrome]
76
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects
(Creative Control Mode)
Recording mode:
This mode records with additional picture effects. You can set the effects to be applied to
a picture by selecting a sample picture and checking them simultaneously on the screen.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Press to select the picture effect
(filters)
Preview display
• You can also select the picture effects (filters) by
touching the example images.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the Recording
mode icon in recording screen.
60
p
Switching the display of a selection screen for applying picture effects (Filter)
Depending on the picture effect, the recording screen may seem as if frames are missed.
[White Balance] will be fixed to [AWB] and ISO sensitivity to [AUTO].
The following menu items can be set in the [ ] menu.
[Filter Effect]: Allows you to set the picture effect (filter). (→172)
[Simultaneous record w/o filter]: Allows you to set the camera to take a
picture with and without an picture effect simultaneously. (→173)
77
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects (Creative Control Mode)
Types of picture effects
Displaying the description of each picture effect (Filter)
Press [DISP.] button while the picture effect selection screen is displayed
When it is set to the guide display, explanations for each picture effect are displayed.
Normal display Guide display List display
Setting the type of defocus ([Miniature Effect])
After touching [ ], touch [ ]
Press or to move the focusing area (frame)
You can also move the in-focus portion by touching the screen on
the recording screen.
Touching [
] allows you to set the recording orientation (defocus
orientation).
Rotate the rear dial to select the size of the focusing area
(frame)
On the touch screen, spread (pinch out) your 2 fingers to zoom in,
and pinch (pinch in) your 2 fingers to zoom out. (→39)
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is
restored.
Press [MENU/SET]
No audio is recorded for motion pictures.
When a motion picture is recorded, the finished recording will be approximately 1/10th of the
actual recorded time period. (If you record a motion picture for 10 minutes, the resulting motion
picture recording time will be approximately 1 minute.) The recordable time displayed on the
camera is approx. 10 times of the actual recording time.
If you stop recording motion pictures too soon, the camera may continue recording until a certain
time.
78
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects (Creative Control Mode)
Selecting the color to be retained ([One Point Color])
After touching [ ], touch [ ]
Select the color to be retained with and press
[MENU/SET]
You can also select it by touch operations.
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is
restored.
The selected color may not be retained for some subjects.
Setting the position and size of the light source ([Sunshine])
After touching [ ], touch [ ]
Press to move the center of the light source to a different position
The position of the light source can also be moved by touching the screen.
Rotate the rear dial to adjust the size of the light source
On the touch screen, spread (pinch out) your 2 fingers to zoom in, and pinch (pinch in) your 2
fingers to zoom out.
When you press [DISP.] button, the initial setting condition is restored.
Press [MENU/SET]
Tips on positioning the center of the light source
You can move the center of the light source to a point outside the image to obtain a more natural
finish.
79
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects (Creative Control Mode)
Adjusting the picture effects according to your preferences
You can easily adjust the setting conditions (such as degree and coloring of an effect) of
the picture effects according to your preferences.
1
Press to display the setting screen
2
Rotate the rear dial to adjust the setting conditions of
the picture effects
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
Picture effect Items that can be set
[Expressive] Vividness
Subdued coloring
Gaudy coloring
[Retro] Coloring
Yellowish coloring
Reddish coloring
[Old Days] Contrast
Low contrast
High contrast
[High Key] Coloring
Pinkish coloring
Light-bluish coloring
[Low Key] Coloring
Reddish coloring
Bluish coloring
[Sepia] Contrast
Low contrast
High contrast
[Monochrome] Coloring
Yellowish coloring
Bluish coloring
[Dynamic Monochrome] Contrast
Low contrast
High contrast
[Rough Monochrome] Grainy picture effect
Weak grainy picture effect
Strong grainy picture effect
[Silky Monochrome] Degree of defocusing
Slight defocusing
Strong defocusing
[Impressive Art] Vividness
Black & white
Gaudy coloring
[High Dynamic] Vividness
Black & white
Gaudy coloring
80
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects (Creative Control Mode)
Picture effect Items that can be set
[Cross Process] Coloring
Greenish coloring / Bluish coloring /
Yellowish coloring / Reddish coloring
Select the desired color tone by rotating
the rear dial, and press [MENU/SET].
[Toy Effect] Coloring
Orangish coloring
Bluish coloring
[Toy Pop] Range in which peripheral brightness is reduced
Small
Large
[Bleach Bypass] Contrast
Low contrast
High contrast
[Miniature Effect] Vividness
Subdued coloring
Gaudy coloring
For details about [Miniature Effect] (→77)
[Soft Focus] Degree of defocusing
Slight defocusing
Strong defocusing
[Fantasy] Vividness
Subdued coloring
Gaudy coloring
[Star Filter]
Length of the rays of light
Rays of light is short
Rays of light is long
Number of the rays of light
Smaller
Larger
Angle of the rays of light
Rotate to the left
Rotate to the right
[One Point Color] Amount of color retained
Leaves a small amount of
color
Leaves a large amount of
color
For details about [One Point Color] (→78)
[Sunshine] Coloring
Yellowish coloring / Reddish coloring /
Bluish coloring / Whitish coloring
Rotate the rear dial to select coloring, and
press [MENU/SET].
For details about [Sunshine] (→78)
81
SQW0721
Recording mode
Taking Pictures with different picture effects (Creative Control Mode)
Setting brightness (exposure)
1
Press to display the setting screen
Each press of [Fn1] button switches between blur control operation (below), and operation finish.
2
Rotate the rear dial to set
Press in the brightness setting screen to set the exposure
bracket. (→131)
OFF
Taking a picture with a blurred background (Defocus control function)
1
After pressing in step
1
of “Setting brightness (exposure)” (above), press the
[Fn1] button to display the setting screen
2
Rotate the rear dial to set
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
Pressing [Q.MENU/
] button on the blurriness setting screen
will cancel the setting.
500
00
250 125 60 30
4.02.81.4 2.0
With touch screen operations
Touch [ ]
Touch the item you want to set
[ ]: Adjusting the picture effect
[ ]: Degree of defocusing
[ ]: Brightness (exposure)
Drag the slide bar to set
Press [MENU/SET] to return to the recording screen.
This function is not available in the following case:
[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
82
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording motion pictures by setting the aperture
value/shutter speed
(Creative Video Mode)
Recording mode:
You can record motion pictures by manually setting the aperture value and shutter speed.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Set the menu (→42)
[Motion Picture] → [Exposure Mode]
Settings: [P] / [A] / [S] / [M]
• When it is set to [A], [S] or [M], the operation for changing the aperture value or
shutter speed is the same as the operation for setting the mode dial to [
], [ ]
or [ ].
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the Recording mode
icon in recording screen.
60
p
3
Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) to start
recording
4
Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) to stop
recording
When [Exposure Mode] is set to [M], [AUTO] of the ISO sensitivity will switch to [125].
83
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording motion pictures by setting the aperture value/shutter speed (Creative Video Mode)
Recording Slow Motion Pictures ([High Speed Video])
Slow motion pictures can be recorded by performing recording at a super high speed.
When these recordings are played back, the motion is displayed slowly.
• To record pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Set the menu (→42)
[Motion Picture] → [High Speed Video] → [ON]
Recording is done at 120 frames/second with [FHD] in [MP4].
3
Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) to start recording
4
Press the motion picture button (or shutter button) to stop recording
No sound is recorded.
Files are split into smaller motion picture files for recording and playback when the file size
exceeds 4 GB. (You can continue to record motion pictures without interruption.)
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds.
(In terms of playback time, you can record up to approximately 120 minutes.)
The settings for the focus, zoom, exposure and White Balance are fixed to the settings specified
when recording was started.
Flickering or horizontal stripes may appear while recording under fluorescent lighting.
84
SQW0721
Recording mode
Recording motion pictures by setting the aperture value/shutter speed (Creative Video Mode)
Minimizing operational sounds during motion picture
recording
The operational sound of the zoom or button operation may be recorded when it is
operated during the recording of a motion picture. Using touch icons allows silent
operation while recording motion pictures.
[Motion Picture] → [Silent Operation] → [ON]
1
Start recording
2
Touch [ ]
3
Touch icon
Zoom
Shutter speed
Exposure Compensation
ISO sensitivity
4
Drag the slide bar to set
The speed of the operation varies depending on the position
you touch.
[ ] / [ ] Changes the setting slowly
[
] / [ ]
Changes the setting quickly
5
Stop recording
Cannot be used during [High Speed Video] recording.
85
SQW0721
Recording mode
Registering your own settings and recording
(Custom Mode)
Recording mode:
Registering your own settings ([Cust.Set Mem.])
Up to 3 sets of current camera settings can be registered using [Cust.Set Mem.].
([ ], [ ], [ ])
• Initial setting of the Program AE Mode is registered as the custom settings initially.
Preparations
Select the recording mode you wish to register and set the [Rec] menu, [Motion Picture] menu, [Setup]
menu, etc.
[Custom] → [Cust.Set Mem.]
→ Custom set where you want to register settings
The following menu items are not registered as custom settings.
[Rec] menu [Setup] menu
Data registered with [Face Recog.]
The [Profile Setup] setting
All menus
[Custom] menu [Playback] menu
[Touch Scroll]
[Menu Guide]
[Rotate Disp.]
[Picture Sort]
86
SQW0721
Recording mode
Registering your own settings and recording (Custom Mode)
Recording using registered custom set
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
The custom set you used last time will be called up.
To change a custom set
Set mode dial to [ ]
Press [MENU/SET] to bring up the menu
Press to select the custom set you want to use, and press [MENU/SET]
The settings are switched to those settings you selected for the
custom set.
60
p
It is also possible to display the selection screen by touching the Recording mode
icon in recording screen.
60
p
Changing the registered content
Even if the menu settings are changed temporarily when the mode dial has been set to
[
], the currently registered settings will remain unchanged. To change the currently
registered settings, overwrite the registered data using [Cust.Set Mem.] on the [Custom]
menu.
87
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Recording mode:
By setting the optimum Focus Mode or Auto Focus Mode for the subject or recording
condition, you can let the camera automatically adjust focus in various scenes.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select [AF] and press
[MENU/SET]
• Set the focusing action when the shutter is pressed
halfway (→88)
• Switch the Auto Focus mode (→89)
3
Press the shutter button halfway
Focus display
( When focus is aligned: illuminated
When focus is not aligned: flashing)
AF area
(When focus is aligned: green)
• Two “beep” sounds are heard and Auto Focus is activated.
Four “beep” sounds when focus is not aligned.
• When you take a picture in a dark location, [ ] is displayed for the focus display
and it may take longer to adjust focus than usual.
• If the camera detects stars in the night sky after displaying [ ], Starlight AF will
be activated. When focus is achieved, the focus indication [ ] and AF areas in
focus are displayed.
(Detection with Starlight AF works only for approximately 1/3 of the center area of
the screen.)
Subjects/environments which may make focusing difficult:
Fast-moving or extremely bright objects, or objects with no color contrast.
Taking pictures through glass or near objects emitting light.
In the dark, or with significant jitter.
When too close to object or when taking pictures of both distant and close objects together in
the same picture.
88
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Set the focusing operation to be performed when the shutter
button is pressed halfway (AFS, AFF, AFC)
Recording mode:
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AFS/AFF/AFC]
Settings
The movement of the
subject and the scene
(recommended)
Description
[AFS]
Subject is still
(Scenery, anniversary
photograph, etc.)
“AFS” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Single”. Focus
is set automatically when the shutter button is pressed
halfway.
Focus will be fixed while it is pressed halfway.
[AFF]
Movement cannot be
predicted (Children,
pets, etc.)
“AFF” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Flexible”. In this
mode, focusing is performed automatically when the shutter
button is pressed halfway.
If the subject moves while the shutter button is pressed
halfway, the focus is corrected to match the movement
automatically.
[AFC]
Subject is moving
(Sport, trains, etc.)
“AFC” is an abbreviation of “Auto Focus Continuous”. In
this mode, while the shutter button is pressed halfway,
focusing is constantly performed to match the movement
of the subject. When the subject is moving, the focusing is
performed by predicting the subject position at the time of
recording. (Movement prediction)
When recording using [AFF], [AFC]
Focusing may take time if the zoom is suddenly changed from max. Wide to max. Tele, or if you
suddenly move closer to a subject from a greater distance.
Press the shutter button halfway again when it is difficult to focus on the subject.
While the shutter button pressed halfway, shake may be seen on the screen.
If the light on a subject is insufficient when using [AFF] or [AFC], the camera performs the same
focusing operation as [AFS]. In this case, the indication on the screen will change to yellow [AFS].
[AFC] in [AFS/AFF/AFC] operates as [AFS] in the following case:
When recording with [
] ([4K Burst(S/S)]) of the 4K Photo function.
It is fixed to [AFS] when panorama mode is set.
[AFF] is not available when recording 4K photos. Continuous AF works during recording.
This setting cannot be used when recording using [Post Focus].
89
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Switching [AF Mode]
Recording mode:
This allows the focusing method that suits the positions and number of the subjects to be
selected.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AF Mode]
Settings: [
] (Face/Eye Detection) / [ ] (Tracking) / [ ] (49-area-focusing) /
[ ] etc. (Custom Multi) / [ ] (1-area-focusing) / [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing)
(→90 - 94)
In Intelligent Auto Mode and Intelligent Auto Plus Mode, [ ] or [ ] can be set.
The [AF Mode] is fixed to [ ] (Face/Eye Detection) in the following case:
In Self Shot Mode (If [
] is not available with the current recording mode, an available focus
setting for each recording mode will be used.)
Auto Focus is fixed to [ ] (1-area-focusing) in the following cases:
When using the Digital Zoom
[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
Setting cannot be made during recording in [Post Focus] or when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
90
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Taking front-on pictures of people (Face/Eye Detection)
The camera automatically detects the faces and eyes of subjects. The camera adjusts
the focus on the eye that is closer to the camera and the exposure using the face (when
[Metering Mode] is set to [ ] (Multi Metering)).
• The camera can detect up to 15 faces. The camera can detect only the eyes of faces to
be focused on.
When the camera recognized a face, the AF area and eye
used for focusing are displayed.
Eye used for focusing
Yellow: When the shutter button is pressed halfway and the
subject is focused, the frame turns green.
White: Displayed when more than one face is detected.
Other faces that are the same distance away as faces
within the yellow AF area are also focused.
Changing the eye to be in focus
Touch the eye to be used for focusing
If you touch a location outside the yellow frame, the AF area setting
screen will be displayed. (→95)
If you touch [
] or press [MENU/SET], the eye focus setting will be
canceled.
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape], [Artistic Nightscape],
[Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld Night Shot], [Appetizing Food], [Cute Dessert] (Scene Guide
Mode)
The Eye Detection cannot be changed when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
If conditions prevent the face from being recognized, such as when the movement of the subject is
too rapid, the AF Mode setting switches to [
] (49-area-focusing).
91
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Automatically locking the focus on a moving subject (tracking)
With cursor button operations
Align the AF Tracking frame with the subject and press
the shutter button halfway
AF Tracking frame
When the subject is recognized, the AF Tracking frame changes from
white to yellow, and the subject is automatically kept in focus.
To release AF Tracking → Press [MENU/SET].
Focus range: same as macro recording [
]
With touch screen operations
Touch the subject
Perform these operations with the touch shutter function released.
The AF area turns yellow while the subject is locked.
To release AF Tracking → Touch [
].
If AF Lock fails, a red frame flashes for a while and then turns off.
When you set [Metering Mode] to [ ] (Multi Metering), the camera adjusts the exposure using a
locked subject. (→175)
Under certain recording conditions, such as when the subject is small or dark, [ ] may not
operate correctly. When [
] does not work, focus will be on [ ] (1-area-focusing).
This function is not available in the following case:
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
In the following cases, [ ] performs the operation of [ ] (1-area-focusing).
[Glistening Water], [Glittering Illuminations], [Soft Image of a Flower], [Monochrome]
(Scene Guide Mode)
[Sepia], [Monochrome], [Dynamic Monochrome], [Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome],
[Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
[Monochrome] ([Photo Style])
92
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Subject not centered in picture (49-area-focusing)
Focuses on the subject in the wide range area (up to 49-area-
focusing) on the recording screen.
Setting the shape of an AF area , etc. (Custom Multi)
You can set the preferred shape of an AF area by selecting 49 points in the AF area,
based on the subject.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AF Mode]
1
Select a Custom Multi icon ([ ], etc.), and press
Current AF area shape
2
Use to select the setting item
([Horizontal
Pattern])
Horizontal line shape
Ideal shape for panning,
etc.
([Vertical
Pattern])
Vertical line shape
Ideal shape for recording
structures, etc.
([Central
Pattern])
Shape distributed over
the center
Ideal shape for focusing
around the center.
/ /
(Custom)
You can set a custom registration shape.
3
Press
The AF area setting screen appears.
93
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
4
Select the AF area
Selected AF area
When selecting [ ] / [ ] / [ ]
Operation
Touch
operation
Description
Touch Moves position
Pinch out /
Pinch in
Changes the size (3 stages)
[DISP.] [Reset]
Restores to the initial
settings
When selecting [ ] / [ ] / [ ]
With cursor button operations
Use to select AF area and press [MENU/SET] to set
(repeat)
If you press [MENU/SET] again, the setting will be canceled.
To cancel all the settings, press the [DISP.] button.
With touch screen operations
Touch the parts you want to set as AF areas
If you touch one of the selected AF areas, the selection of the
area will be canceled.
5
Press [Fn2] button
Registering the set AF area in [ ], [ ] and [ ] (Custom)
Press on the screen of step
2
Use to select the registration target icon and press [MENU/SET]
The settings adjusted in [ ], [ ] or [ ] will be restored to the default settings when the
camera is turned off.
94
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Determined position for focus (1-area-focusing) /
(Pinpoint-focusing)
(1-area-focusing)
Focuses on AF area in center of picture. (Recommended when focus is difficult to align)
When the subject is not in the center of the composition in [ ], you can bring the subject
into the AF area, fix the focus and exposure by pressing the shutter button halfway, move the
camera to the composition you want with the shutter button pressed halfway, and then take the
picture. (Only when [AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu is set to [AFS].)
(Pinpoint-focusing)
Enables more precise focusing on a smaller point than [ ] (1-area-focusing). When you
press the shutter button halfway, an enlarged display of the focus position appears.
If [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing) is selected while recording motion pictures or 4K photos, the setting is
changed to [
] (1-area-focusing).
Cannot set to [ ] (Pinpoint-focusing) in the following case:
When [AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu is set to [AFF] or [AFC]
95
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Changing the position and size of the AF area
Recording mode:
When [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] in Auto Focus Mode is selected, you can change the
position and size of the AF area.
• Perform these operations with the touch shutter function released.
• You can also display the AF area setting screen by touching the recording screen.
(When [Touch AF] in [Touch Settings] of the [Custom] menu has been set to [AF].)
When you set [Metering Mode] (→175) to [ ] (spot-focusing), the metering target will move
along with the AF area.
The position and size of the AF area cannot be changed in the Digital Zoom range.
When selecting [ ] / [ ]
You can change the position and size of the AF area.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AF Mode]
Select [ ] or [ ] and press
The AF area setting screen appears.
To change the AF area
Operation Touch operation Description
Touch To move the position of the AF area.
Pinch out /
Pinch in
Enlarges/reduces the AF area in small steps.
Enlarges/reduces the AF area in large steps.
[DISP.] [Reset]
Resets the AF area back to the center.
If you press the button again, the frame size will be
reset to the initial setting.
Press [MENU/SET]
AF area with the same function as [ ] is displayed in the touched position, when the [ ] is
selected. Setting of the AF area is cleared when [MENU/SET] is pressed or [
] is touched.
96
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
When selecting [ ]
You can set the focus position by selecting an AF area group. The AF area, which is
configured with 49 points, is divided into groups consisting of 9 points each (6 points or 4
points for the groups located at the edges of the screen).
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AF Mode]
Select [ ] and press
The AF area setting screen appears.
Examples of group
Press to select an AF area group
Press [MENU/SET]
Only the [+] indications (center points of the selected group) remain on the
screen.
Setting of the AF area is cleared when [MENU/SET] is pressed or [
] is
touched.
97
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
When selecting [ ]
You can enlarge the screen to perform more precise settings of the focus position.
• You cannot set the focus position at the edges of the screen.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [AF Mode]
Select [ ] and press
Use to set the focus position and press
[MENU/SET]
The enlarged assist screen will appear for setting the focus
position.
Move [+] to the focus position
Operation Touch operation Description
Touch Moves [+].
Pinch in / Pinch out Enlarges/reduces the AF area in small steps.
Enlarges/reduces the AF area in large steps.
Switches the enlarged display. (windowed/full
screen)
[DISP.] [Reset] Resets [+] back to the center.
The image of a part of the screen can be enlarged or reduced approximately 3 to 6 times. The
image of the entire screen can be enlarged or reduced approximately 3 to 10 times.
On the assist screen, it is also possible to record a picture by touching [
].
98
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Auto Focus
Optimizing the focus and brightness for a touched position
Recording mode:
You can optimize the focus and brightness for the position you have touched.
[Custom] → [Touch Settings] → [Touch AF] → [AF+AE]
1
Touch the subject you want to optimize the brightness
for
The AF area setting screen appears. (→95)
The brightness optimization position is displayed on the center of
the AF area. The position follows the movement of the AF area.
[Metering Mode] is set to [
], which is used exclusively for the
[Touch AE].
Touching [Reset] returns the brightness optimization position and
the AF area to the center.
SetSet
Reset
Reset
2
Touch [Set]
The AF area with the same function as [ ] is displayed on the touched position.
If you touch [
] (touch [ ] when [ ] is set), the setting of [AF+AE] is canceled.
When the background has become too bright, etc., the
brightness contrast with the background can be adjusted by
compensating the exposure.
When recording with the Touch Shutter, the focus and brightness are optimized for the touched
position before recording takes place.
At the edge of the screen, the metering may be affected by the brightness around the touched
location.
The [AF+AE] does not function in the following cases:
When using the Digital Zoom
When the AF area has been set by using the cursor button
When [4K Live Cropping] is set
99
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking close-up pictures
(Macro recording)
Recording mode:
This mode allows you to take close-up pictures of a subject, e.g. when taking pictures of
flowers.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the item and press
[MENU/SET]
[ ]
([AF Macro])
You can take pictures of a subject as close as 3 cm (0.098 feet) from the
lens by rotating the zoom lever upmost to Wide.
[
]
([Macro Zoom])
Use this setting to get close to the subject and then further enlarge when
taking the picture. You can take a picture with the Digital Zoom up to 3x
while maintaining the distance to the subject for the extreme Wide position
(3 cm (0.098 feet)).
Note that enlarging will decrease picture quality.
Zoom range will be displayed in blue. (digital zoom range)
When recording a subject close to the camera, we recommend taking a picture without using the
flash.
A picture may be out of focus when the subject is out of focus range, even if the focus display is lit.
When a nearby subject is to be recorded
Using a tripod and [Self Timer] (→129) is recommended.
The effective focus range (depth of field) is significantly narrowed. Therefore, if the distance
between the camera and the subject is changed after focusing on the subject, it may become
difficult to focus on it again.
Resolution may be slightly reduced around the edges of the picture. This is not a malfunction.
Cannot set to [Macro Zoom] in the following cases:
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
Panorama Shot Mode
During [High Speed Video] recording
[Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
100
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Recording mode:
Manual Focus is convenient when you want to lock the focus to take pictures or when it is
difficult to adjust focus using Auto Focus.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select [MF] and press
[MENU/SET]
3
Turn the control ring to adjust focus
Turning the control ring to the right:
Focusing on a nearby subject
Turning the control ring to the left:
Focusing on a distant subject
MF Assist (Enlarged screen)
Peaking
MF Guide
• The screen changes to the assist screen and an
enlarged display appears. (MF Assist) (→191)
You can also enlarge the area by pinching out (→39)
the screen.
Color is added to the portions of the image that are
in focus. (Peaking) (→192)
About the MF Guide (→192)
101
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Manual Focus
Operation Touch operation Description
Drag Moves the enlarged area.
Pinch in /
Pinch out
Enlarges/reduces the AF area in small steps.
Enlarges/reduces the AF area in large steps.
*
1
Switches the enlarged display. (windowed/full screen)
*
2
[DISP.] [Reset] Resets the area to be enlarged back to the center.
*
1
This setting is not available in Intelligent Auto Mode.
*
2
The image of a part of the screen can be enlarged or reduced approximately 3 to 6 times.
The image of the entire screen can be enlarged or reduced approximately 3 to 10 times.
4
Press the shutter button halfway
• The assist screen will close. The recording screen will be displayed.
• You can also exit MF Assist by pressing [MENU/SET].
Quickly adjusting the focus using Auto Focus
In Manual Focus, the focus can be set on the subject through Auto Focus. (One shot AF)
1
Touch [ ]
Auto Focus is activated at the center of the frame.
Auto Focus also works with the following operations.
Pressing the function button to which [AF-ON] is assigned
Dragging the monitor and releasing your finger at the position
you want to focus on
One-shot AF cannot be used when [4K Live Cropping] is set.
102
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures by locking the focus and/or exposure
(AF/AE Lock)
Recording mode:
The AF/AE Lock function is convenient, for example, when there is too much contrast with
the subject and you cannot get appropriate exposure (AE Lock) or when you want to take
a still picture composed with the subject outside the AF area (AF Lock).
Preparation
To execute the AF/AE Lock function, it is necessary to register [AF/AE LOCK] to the function button.
(→46)
1
Point the camera at the subject
2
Lock the focus and/or exposure while you press and hold the
function button
• When you release the function button, the focus and/or exposure lock is canceled.
3
While you press and hold the function button, move the
camera to compose the picture you want to take and fully
press the shutter button
Setting the function of the function button where [AF/AE LOCK] is registered
[Custom] → [AF/AE Lock]
[AE LOCK]
Locks exposure only.
[AEL] is displayed when the correct exposure is achieved.
[AF LOCK]
Locks focus only.
[AFL] is displayed when the subject comes into focus.
[AF/AE LOCK]
Locks focus and exposure.
[AFL] and [AEL] are displayed when the subject is in focus and the correct
exposure is achieved.
[AF-ON] Auto Focus is activated.
AF Lock only is effective in the following case:
Manual Exposure Mode
During Manual Focus, only AE Lock can be used.
The subject can be focused again by pressing the shutter button halfway, even when AE is locked.
Program Shift can be set even when AE is locked.
103
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Taking pictures with Exposure Compensation
Recording mode:
Corrects the exposure when there is a backlight or when the subject is too dark or too
bright.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Rotate the rear dial to compensate the
exposure
Exposure Bracket
Exposure Compensation
• You can perform the operations below while the
exposure compensation screen is displayed.
Compensates the exposure
Sets the exposure bracket (→131)
OFF
Under-exposed
Optimum
exposure
Over-exposed
Adjust the
exposure to the [+]
direction
Adjust the
exposure to the [-]
direction
3
Press [MENU/SET] to set
• You can also press the shutter button halfway to set.
You can set the exposure compensation value in the range between –5 EV and +5 EV.
Settings can be made within a range of –3 EV to +3 EV while recording motion pictures, recording
4K photos, or recording in [Post Focus].
Depending on the brightness, this may not be possible in some cases.
The set Exposure Compensation value is stored even if the camera is turned off. (When [Exposure
Comp. Reset] (→204) is set to [OFF])
104
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Setting the ISO Sensitivity
Recording mode:
Set ISO sensitivity (sensitivity to lighting).
We recommend higher settings to take clear pictures in darker locations.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [Sensitivity]
1
Select the ISO sensitivity by rotating the
rear dial
ISO sensitivity
2
Press [MENU/SET]
• You can also press the shutter button halfway to set.
AUTO
ISO sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200
*
1
depending on the
brightness of a subject.
(Intelligent ISO)
ISO sensitivity is automatically set in a range up to 3200
*
1
depending on the
movement and brightness of a subject.
The shutter speed is not fixed when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
It is continuously changing to match the movement of the subject until the
shutter button is pressed fully.
80
*
2
/100
*
2
/
from 125 to 12800/
25600
*
2
ISO sensitivity is fixed at the selected setting.
*
1
When [ISO Limit Set] (→181) is set to other than [OFF], the ISO sensitivity is automatically set in
the range up to the [ISO Limit Set] setting value.
*
2
Only when [Extended ISO] is [ON].
105
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Setting the ISO Sensitivity
Setting guide
ISO sensitivity [125] [12800]
Location
(recommended)
Bright
(outdoors)
Dark
Shutter speed Slow Fast
Interference Low High
Subject blur High Low
For details on the available flash range used when the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO], refer to
(→145).
Cannot select [ ] in the following cases:
Shutter-Priority AE Mode
Manual Exposure Mode
When [Multi Exp.] is set, the maximum setting is [3200].
You can use the following settings in the Creative Video Mode, when recording 4K photos, or
when recording using [Post Focus].
[AUTO], [125] - [6400]
106
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Recording mode:
In sunlight, under incandescent lights or in other such conditions where the color of white
takes on a reddish or bluish tinge, this item adjusts to the color of white which is closest to
what is seen by the eye in accordance with the light source.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Rotate the rear dial to select the White Balance
[AWB] Automatic adjustment in accordance with the light source.
[
]
Adjust to the color under a clear sky.
[
]
Adjust to the color under a cloudy sky.
[
]
Adjust to the color in the shade.
[
]
Adjust to the color under incandescent lights.
[
]
*
Adjust to the color that is optimal for taking pictures using the flash.
[
]/[ ]/
[
]/[ ]
Use the White Balance value that was set manually.
Press
Point the camera at a white object such as a piece of paper, ensuring that it is
inside the frame at the center of the screen, and press the shutter button
This will set the White Balance and return you to the recording screen.
The same operation can be performed by pressing [MENU/SET].
It may not be possible to set the correct White Balance if subjects are too
bright or too dark. In this case, adjust the brightness and try to set the
White Balance again.
[
]
You can set the White Balance using color temperature.
Press
Use to select the color temperature value and
press [MENU/SET]
You can set the color temperature from [2500K] to
[10000K].
*
The [AWB] setting is applied while recording motion pictures, recording 4K photos, or
recording in [Post Focus].
3
Press [MENU/SET] to finalize the setting
• You can also press the shutter button halfway to set the White Balance.
107
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Under fluorescent lighting, LED lighting fixtures, etc., the optimal White Balance will vary
depending on the lighting type, so use [AWB], [
], [ ], [ ] or [ ].
The White Balance may not operate correctly if you take pictures using a flash and the subject is
recorded outside of the effective flash range (→145).
In Scene Guide Mode, changing the scene or recording mode will return White Balance settings
(including the White Balance fine adjustment setting) back to [AWB].
In the Scene Guide Mode, settings suitable for each scene are made.
Auto White Balance
When [AWB] (Automatic White Balance) is set, the coloring is adjusted in accordance
with the light source. However, if the scene is too bright or too dark or if other extreme
conditions apply, the pictures may appear reddish or bluish. The White Balance may not
operate correctly if there is a multiple number of light sources. In that case, set the [White
Balance] to settings other than [AWB] to adjust the coloring.
: [AWB] operational range
10000K
9000K
8000K
7000K
6000K
5000K
4000K
3000K
2000K
Cloudy sky (rain)
Shade
Incandescent lighting
Sunset/sunrise
Candlelight
Sunlight
White fluorescent lighting
Blue sky
108
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Performing White Balance fine adjustments
White Balance settings can be individually fine-tuned if colors still do not appear as
anticipated.
1
In step
2
of “Adjusting the White Balance” (→106),
select the White Balance and press
2
Use to perform White Balance fine
adjustments
: A (amber: orangish colors)
: B (blue: bluish colors)
: G (green: greenish colors)
: M (magenta: reddish colors)
You can also make fine adjustments by touching the White
Balance graph.
Pressing [DISP.] button resets the position back to the center.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
4
Press [MENU/SET] to finalize the setting
You can also press the shutter button halfway to set the White Balance.
When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the A (amber) or B (blue) side,
the color of the White Balance icon displayed on the screen will change to the fine-tuned color.
When you perform fine adjustments of the White Balance toward the G (green) or M (magenta)
side, [+] (green) or [-] (magenta) will be displayed in the White Balance icon on the screen.
109
SQW0721
Focus, Brightness (Exposure) and Color tone Settings
Adjusting the White Balance
Bracket recording using White Balance
Bracket settings are performed based on the fine adjustment values for White Balance,
and three pictures with different coloring are automatically recorded when the shutter
button is pressed once.
1
Perform fine adjustments of the White Balance in
step
2
of “Performing White Balance fine adjustments”
(→108) and rotate the rear dial to perform the Bracket
setting
You can also set the bracket by touching [ ]/[ ].
BKTBKT
2
Press [MENU/SET]
3
Press [MENU/SET] to finalize the setting
You can also press the shutter button halfway to set the White Balance.
You can also set the White Balance Bracket in [Bracket] in the [Rec] menu. (→130)
This function is not available in the following cases:
Panorama Shot Mode
[Glistening Water], [Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld Night Shot], [Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
When using [Burst]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When taking still pictures while a motion picture is being recorded
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
110
SQW0721
Recording 4K Photos
Recording mode:
You can select the desired moment from a burst of 4K photos taken at 30 frames/second
and save that moment as a picture of approx. 8 million pixels.
Record a 4K photo Select and save pictures The picture is complete
• To record pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
1
Press [ ] button
• The same operation can be performed by pressing
the [ ] button ( ), using to select a 4K photo
icon ([ ], etc.), and pressing .
2
Press to select the recording method
and press [MENU/SET]
• The recording method can also be set from [4K
PHOTO] in the [Rec] menu.
4K Photo and Drive Settings
111
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
[4K Burst]
For capturing the best shot of a fast-moving subject (e.g., sports,
aeroplanes, trains)
Burst recording is performed while the shutter button is pressed and held. The
shutter sound will be heard repeatedly.
Audio recording: None
[4K Burst(S/S)]
“S/S” is an
abbreviation of
“Start/Stop”.
For capturing unpredictable photo opportunities (e.g., plants, animals,
children)
Burst recording starts when the shutter button is pressed and stops when
pressed again. Start and stop tones will be heard.
Audio recording: Available
*
[4K Pre-Burst]
For recording as needed whenever a photo opportunity arises (e.g. the
moment when a ball is thrown)
Burst recording is performed for approximately 1 second before and after the
moment that the shutter button is pressed. The shutter sound will be heard only
once.
Recording length:
Approximately 2 seconds
Audio recording: None
*
Audio is not played back when you perform playback with the camera.
3
Record a 4K photo
[4K Burst]
Press the shutter button halfway
Press and hold the shutter button fully for as long as you want to
perform recording
Recording will start approximately 0.5 seconds after you press the
shutter button fully. Therefore, press the button fully as soon as
possible.
If you are using Auto Focus, continuous AF will work while recording.
Focus will be adjusted continuously.
If you remove your finger from the shutter button immediately after the
start of recording, up to a period of approximately 1.5 seconds after
the moment that the finger has been removed may be recorded.
Press and hold
Recording is performed
112
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
[4K Burst(S/S)]
“S/S” is an
abbreviation of
“Start/Stop”.
Press the shutter button fully
Recording will start.
If you are using Auto Focus, continuous AF will work while recording.
Focus will be adjusted continuously.
Press the shutter button fully again
Recording will stop.
Start (First)
Stop (Second)
Recording is performed
When you press the [Fn1] button while recording, you can add a
marker. (Up to 40 markers for each recording.) When selecting and
saving pictures from a 4K burst file, you can skip to the positions
where you added markers.
[4K Pre-Burst]
When you press the shutter button halfway, the aperture value and
shutter speed are displayed.
Press the shutter button fully
Auto Focus adjusts focus continuously, and except in Manual
Exposure Mode, it also adjusts exposure continuously.
When recording with [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]), images may not be
displayed as smoothly as when recording with the normal recording
screen.
Approximately 1 second
Recording is performed
In situations where you want to lock focus and exposure, such as
when the subject is not at the center, use [AF/AE LOCK]. (→102)
113
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
• When you perform 4K burst photo recording, a 4K burst file will be saved in the
MP4 format.
• When [Auto Review] is enabled, the picture selection screen will be displayed
automatically. To continue recording, press the shutter button halfway to display
the recording screen.
• For information on how to select and save pictures from recorded 4K burst files,
refer to (→117).
• When using [Light Composition] (→215), we recommend using a tripod and taking
pictures remotely by connecting the camera to a smartphone to prevent camera
shake. (→236).
To cancel the 4K Photo functions
In step
2
, select [ ].
• The operation can be canceled by pressing the [ ] button ( ) and then selecting
[ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
Battery drainage and camera temperature
If the surrounding temperature is high or 4K photos are recorded continuously, [ ] may be
displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through. Wait until the camera cools down.
When [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) is set, the battery drains faster and the camera temperature rises.
(to protect itself, the camera may switch to [
] ([4K Burst]))
Select [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]) only when recording.
Recording stops when the continuous recording time exceeds 15 minutes.
When you are using an SDHC memory card, you can continue recording without interruption even
if the file exceeds 4 GB, but the motion picture file will be recorded and played back in separate
files.
If using an SDXC Memory Card, you can record a motion picture in a single file even if the size is
greater than 4 GB.
114
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
Notes on the 4K Photo function
To change the aspect ratio
Selecting [Aspect Ratio] in the [Rec] menu allows you to change the aspect ratio for 4K
photos.
To record the subject with reduced blur
You can reduce the blur of the subject by setting a faster shutter speed.
Set mode dial to [ ]
Set the shutter speed by rotating the rear dial
Approximate shutter speed for outdoor recording in fine weather conditions: 1/1000 seconds or
faster.
If you increase the shutter speed, the ISO sensitivity becomes higher, which may increase the
noise on the screen.
Shutter sound for 4K photo recording
When using [
] ([4K Burst]) or [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]), recording is performed with the
electronic shutter. You can change the electronic shutter sound settings in [Shutter Vol.]
and [Shutter Tone]. (→200)
When recording with [ ] ([4K Burst(S/S)]), you can set the start/stop tone volume in
[Beep Volume].
• You can perform high speed burst recording quietly using the 4K Photo function in
combination with [Silent Mode]. (→189)
Scenes not suitable for the 4K Photo function
Recording indoors
When recording under fluorescent lighting or LED lighting fixtures, etc., the colors and
brightness may change or horizontal striping may appear on the screen. The striping may
be reduced by setting a slower shutter speed.
Fast-moving subjects
Subjects moving fast may appear distorted when recorded.
115
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
Limitations on the 4K Photo function
To optimize settings for 4K photo recording, certain limitations apply to some recording
functions, menu items and other settings.
• The following settings are fixed.
[Picture Size]
[4K] (8M)
Following picture sizes will be applied:
[4:3]: 3238×2496 [3:2]: 3504×2336
[16:9]: 3840×2160 [1:1]: 2880×2880
[Quality] [
]
[Shutter Type] [ESHTR]
[Rec Format]
*
[MP4]
[Rec Quality]
*
[4K/100M/30p]
[Continuous AF]
*
[ON]
*
Settings in the [Motion Picture] menu are not applied to 4K burst files recorded with the 4K Photo
function.
• The following limitations apply to the recording functions indicated below.
[ ] ([4K Burst])/
[
] ([4K Burst(S/S)])
[
] ([4K Pre-Burst])
Program Shift
Exposure compensation –3 EV to +3 EV
Shutter speed 1/30 to 1/16000
[AFS/AFF/AFC] ([AFF])
[AF Mode] ([
])
[MF Assist]
White Balance ([
])
ISO sensitivity [AUTO], 125 to 6400
Flash
Bracket recording
116
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Recording 4K Photos
• The following menu items are disabled:
[Rec]
[Picture Size], [Quality], [Bracket], [iHandheld Night Shot], [iHDR], [HDR],
[Panorama Settings], [Shutter Type], [Flash], [Extended ISO], [Long Shtr NR],
[Color Space], [Face Recog.], [Profile Setup]
[Custom] [Rec Area]
[Setup]
[Economy] (Only [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]))
When recording, the angle of view becomes narrower.
The following changes occur when recording 4K photos:
The [i.Resolution] setting changes from [EXTENDED] to [LOW].
[Destination] in [Travel Date] cannot be recorded.
[Simultaneous record w/o filter] is not available.
When recording using the [ ] ([4K Pre-Burst]) function, [Step Zoom] does not operate.
Scene Detection in Intelligent Auto Mode works the same way as when recording motion pictures.
The 4K Photo function is disabled when using the following settings:
In Self Shot Mode
[Clear in Backlight], [Glistening Water], [Artistic Nightscape], [Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld
Night Shot], [Clear Night Portrait], [Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter],
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
During motion picture recording
When [Multi Exp.] is set
117
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
This section describes how to select pictures from a 4K burst file and save them.
For details on how to record 4K burst files, refer to (→110).
1
Select a picture with the [ ] on the playback screen,
and press
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
In the case of recording with [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]), proceed to
the step
3
.
2
Drag the slide bar to perform rough scene selection
For information on how to operate the slide view screen, refer to
(→118).
In the case of recording with [
] ([4K Burst]) or [ ] ([4K
Burst(S/S)]), if you touch [
] (or press the [Fn2] button), you
can choose a scene in the 4K burst playback screen. (→119)
Slide view screen
3
Drag to select the frame you want to save as a picture
The same operation can be performed using .
4
Touch [ ] to save the picture
If you use [4K PHOTO Bulk Saving] in the [Playback] menu, you can bulk save 5 seconds’
worth of 4K recording. (→215)
The picture will be saved in JPEG format.
The picture will be saved with recording information (Exif information), including its shutter speed,
aperture and ISO sensitivity information.
118
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
<Slide view screen>
Position of the displayed frame
Operation Touch operation Description
Drag
Selects the frame you want to save as a picture
You can select a frame from 60 frames (continuous burst
time of approximately 2 seconds).
Select
with
→ [MENU/SET]
Display the previous or next 45 frames in slide view
Pressing the same button again will display the frames
following the next ones or the ones preceding the previous
ones.
Touch / Drag
Selects the frames to be displayed
Frames preceding and following the selected frame will be
displayed in slide view.
Pinch out /
Pinch in
Enlarges/reduces the display
Drag Moves the enlarged area (during enlarged display)
[Fn1]
Switches to marker operation
[Fn2]
Displays the 4K burst playback screen
/
Adds/deletes a marker
In-focus portions are highlighted with color. ([Peaking])
Switches in order of [
] → [ ] ([LOW]) →
[
] ([HIGH]).
[MENU/SET]
Saves the picture
During marker operation, you can skip to the markers that you added or the beginning or end of the
4K burst file. Press [Fn1] button again to return to the original operation.
Operation Touch operation Description
Moves to the next marker.
Moves to the previous marker.
119
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
<4K burst playback screen>
During pause During continuous playback
Operation Touch operation Description
/
Continuous playback / Pause (during continuous playback/
rewind)
/
Continuous rewind / Pause (rewind)
/
Fast forward playback / Single-frame forward (while paused)
/
Fast rewind playback / Single-frame rewind (while paused)
Touch / Drag
Selects the frames to be displayed (while paused)
Pinch out /
Pinch in
Enlarges/reduces the display (while paused)
Drag Moves the enlarged area (during enlarged display)
[Fn1]
Switches to marker operation
[Fn2]
Displays the slide view screen (while paused)
/
Adds/deletes a marker
In-focus portions are highlighted with color. ([Peaking])
Switches in order of [
] → [ ] ([LOW]) →
[
] ([HIGH]).
[MENU/SET]
Saves the picture (while paused)
If you touch the slide view screen or 4K burst playback screen twice, the screen will be enlarged.
To return to the original display, touch the enlarged screen twice.
To select and save pictures from 4K burst files on a PC, use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”.
(→274) Please note that it is not possible to edit a 4K burst file as a motion picture.
120
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting pictures from 4K burst file and saving
Selecting and saving pictures on the TV screen
• Set [HDMI Mode] to [AUTO] or [4K]. When connecting to a TV that does not support 4K
motion picture, select [AUTO].
• Set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF].
• If you connect the camera to a TV and display 4K burst files on the TV, they will be
displayed only on the 4K burst playback screen.
• Even if you insert the SD card to a 4K-compatible TV with an SD card slot, you cannot
play back 4K burst files recorded with [Aspect Ratio] set to an option other than [16:9].
(As of October 2016)
121
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Adjusting the focus after recording
([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking])
Recording mode:
You can record bursts of photos with the same quality as a 4K photo while automatically
changing the focus point. After recording, you can select a point on the screen to save a
picture with that point as the focus point. You can combine multiple pictures, each with a
different focus, to increase the focus range. ([Focus Stacking])
This function is best for non-moving subjects.
4K burst recording with
automatic focus shift
Touch the desired focus
point
Finished picture has the
desired focus point
• We recommend using a tripod to perform [Focus Stacking].
• To record pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
Recording using [Post Focus]
1
Press [ ] button
2
Press to select [ON] and press [MENU/SET]
[Post Focus] icon
You can also set it to [ON] by pressing the [
] button ( ), using to select a Post Focus
icon ([
]).
3
Determine the composition and press the shutter
button halfway
Auto Focus activates and automatically detects the focus point
on the screen.
If there is no focus point on the screen, the Focus indicator (
)
blinks and you cannot record.
From halfway pressing the shutter button to completion of recording
Do not change the distance to subject or the composition.
122
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Adjusting the focus after recording ([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking])
4
Press the shutter button fully to start recording
Recording progress bar
The focus point changes automatically while recording. When the
recording progress bar disappears, recording automatically ends.
A motion picture will be recorded in MP4 format. (No audio is
recorded.)
If Auto Review is set, a screen will automatically appear that lets
you select the focus point. (→123)
Canceling [Post Focus]
Select [OFF] in step
2
.
• The operation can be canceled by pressing the [ ] button ( ) and then selecting
[ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
About camera temperature
If the surrounding temperature is high or [Post Focus] recording is performed continuously, [ ] may
be displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through. Wait until the camera cools down.
Limitations in [Post Focus] recording
Since recording is performed in the same picture quality as 4K photos, certain limitations
apply to recording functions and menu settings. For details, refer to “Limitations on the 4K
Photo function” (→115).
• In addition to the limitations of the 4K Photo function, the following limitations apply to
[Post Focus] recording:
Manual Focus cannot be used.
The following menu items are disabled:
[Rec] menu ([AFS/AFF/AFC]/[AF Mode]/[Digital Zoom])
[Custom] menu ([Shutter AF]/[Focus/Release Priority]/[Rec Area]/[Remaining Disp.])
Motion pictures cannot be recorded.
During recording, the angle of view will be narrower.
The [Post Focus] function is disabled when using the following settings:
In Self Shot Mode
[Clear in Backlight], [Glistening Water], [Artistic Nightscape], [Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld
Night Shot], [Clear Night Portrait], [Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter],
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
When [Multi Exp.] is set
123
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Adjusting the focus after recording ([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking])
Select the focus point and save the picture ([Post Focus])
1
On the playback screen, select the image with the
[ ] icon and press
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
2
Touch the focus point
If there are no pictures with the focus on the selected point, a red
frame will be displayed, and pictures cannot be saved.
The edge of the screen cannot be selected.
Operation Touch operation Description
Touch
Select focus point
No selection can be made while display is enlarged.
Enlarge display
Shrink display (when in enlarged display)
[Fn1]
Switches to [Focus Stacking] operation (→124)
[Fn2]
In-focus portions are highlighted with color. ([Peaking])
Switches in order of [
] → [ ] ([LOW])
→ [
] ([HIGH]).
[MENU/SET]
Save picture
You can make fine adjustments to the focus by dragging the
slide bar during enlarged display. (The same operation can be
performed using
.)
124
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Adjusting the focus after recording ([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking])
3
Touch [ ] to save the picture
The picture will be saved in JPEG format.
You cannot choose and save the picture from a TV screen even if the camera is connected to a
TV through an HDMI micro cable.
Combine multiple pictures to increase the focus range
([Focus Stacking])
You can combine multiple pictures from pictures recorded using [Post Focus] to create a
single picture with an expanded focus range.
Near
Focus Distant
1
Touch [ ] on screen in step
2
of “Select the focus point and save the picture
([Post Focus])” (→123)
The same operation can be performed by pressing the [Fn1] button.
2
Choose a stacking method and touch it
[Auto Merging]
Automatically select photos suitable for stacking and combine them into one
picture.
Choose by giving preference to near-focus pictures.
Perform the focus stacking and save the picture.
[Range Merging] Combine the pictures with the selected focus position into one picture.
125
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Adjusting the focus after recording ([Post Focus]/[Focus Stacking])
3
(When selecting [Range Merging])
Touch the focus point
Select positions at two or more points.
Focus positions between the two points are selected and the
range of the in-focus portion is displayed.
The ranges that are grayed out are positions that cannot be
selected, or that would produce an unnatural result if selected
for focus stacking.
Touch a position again to deselect it.
If you drag the screen you can then continue to select positions.
Operation Touch operation Description
Touch Select the touched position
[Fn2] [Set/Cancel] Set/Clear the position
[DISP.]
[All]
Select all positions (Before
selecting position)
[Reset]
Deselect All (After selecting
position)
[MENU/SET]
Combine and save picture
ResetReset
Set/CancelSet/Cancel
ResetReset
Set/CancelSet/Cancel
4
Touch [ ] to combine and save the picture
The picture will be saved in JPEG format with recording information (Exif information) from the
nearest position’s picture, including its shutter speed, aperture and ISO sensitivity information.
In the following cases, [Focus Stacking] may produce an unnatural picture:
If the subject is in motion
If there are large differences in distance to the subject
If there is significant blurring (recording with a larger aperture might make the picture less
unnatural)
Auto compensation is applied to deviations among pictures due to camera shake. In such cases,
the angle of view will be slightly narrower at the time of focus stacking.
Only pictures taken using [Post Focus] are eligible for [Focus Stacking].
126
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting a Drive Mode
Recording mode:
You can switch the operation to be performed when you press the shutter button.
1
Press [ ] button ( )
2
Press to select the drive mode and
press [MENU/SET]
Drive Mode
[Single]
When the shutter button is pressed,
only one picture is recorded.
[Burst] (→127)
The pictures are recorded in succession
while the shutter button is pressed.
[4K PHOTO]
(→110)
When the shutter button is pressed, a
4K photo is recorded.
[Post Focus]
(→121)
When the shutter button is pressed, the
pictures are recorded with [Post Focus].
[Self Timer]
(→129)
When the shutter button is pressed,
recording takes place after the set time
has elapsed.
To cancel the drive mode
In step
2
, select [ ] ([Single]) or [ ].
• You can cancel the self-timer by turning off the camera. (When [Self Timer Auto Off]
(→205) is set to [ON].)
127
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting a Drive Mode
Burst function
Setting [Burst Rate]
After pressing
in step
2
(→126), press to select the
burst rate, and press [MENU/SET]
[SH]
(Super high
speed)
*
1
[H]
(High speed)
[M]
(Middle
speed)
[L]
(Low speed)
Speed
(pictures/
sec.)
[AFS] 50 10 7 2
[AFF] / [AFC] 6 6 2
Live View during burst recording None None Available Available
Number of
recordable
pictures
*
2
With RAW files
13 or more
*
3
Without RAW files 60
Depends on the capacity of the card
*
3
*
1
The electronic shutter starts working, and the [Picture Size] is set to [S].
*
2
The number of burst pictures is limited by the picture-taking conditions and the type and/or status of
the card used.
*
3
Pictures can be taken until the card becomes full. However, the burst speed will become slower
halfway through the recording. The exact time when the slower burst speed will start depends on
the settings of the aspect ratio, picture size, and quality as well as the type of card used.
• The burst speed may become slower depending on the following settings:
[Picture Size] (→174), [Quality] (→174), [Sensitivity] (→104), [AFS/AFF/AFC] (→88),
[Focus/Release Priority] (→191)
128
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting a Drive Mode
Focusing in burst mode
Focusing varies depending on the [AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu (→88) and the setting of [Focus/
Release Priority] (→191) in the [Custom] menu.
[AFS/AFF/AFC] [Focus/Release Priority] Focus
[AFS]
[FOCUS]
At the first picture
[RELEASE]
[AFF] / [AFC]
*
1
[FOCUS]
Normal focusing
*
2
[RELEASE]
Predicted focusing
*
3
*
1
Focus is fixed in the first picture when dark subjects are recorded or the burst speed is set to [SH].
*
2
Since the camera records a burst of pictures while it adjusts the focus, the burst speed may be
slower.
*
3
The camera predicts the focus within a possible range by giving higher priority to the burst speed.
Pictures that are taken while the burst speed is set to [SH] are recorded together as a single burst
group (→166).
When the burst speed is set to [H] and if many burst pictures are taken, the burst speed may be
reduced while burst pictures are being taken.
When the burst speed is set to [SH] or [H] ([AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu is set to [AFS] or the
focus mode is set to [MF]), and the exposure and White Balance are fixed to those of the first
picture.
When the burst speed is set to [H] ([AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu is set to [AFF] or [AFC]), [M], or
[L], and the exposure and White Balance are adjusted individually for each still picture.
It may take a while to store still pictures that were taken using the burst function. If you
continue to record while storing, the number of burst pictures that can be taken will be
reduced. A high-speed card is recommended when recording using the burst function.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
[Glistening Water], [Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld Night Shot], [Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Miniature Effect], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter],
[Sunshine] (Creative Control Mode)
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
During motion picture recording
When recording using the flash (Only when [Burst Rate] is set to [H], [M] or [L])
When [Multi Exp.] is set
[SH] in Burst Mode cannot be used In the following cases:
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
129
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Selecting a Drive Mode
Taking pictures with self-timer
Setting the self-timer operation
After pressing
in step
2
(→126), press to select the
self-timer operation, and press [MENU/SET]
The shutter is activated after 10 seconds.
The shutter is activated after 10 seconds and three pictures
are taken at intervals of approximately 2 seconds.
The shutter is activated after 2 seconds. This is also
effective for preventing jitter when pressing the shutter
button.
After the self-timer indicator flashes, recording will start.
The focus and exposure are fixed when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
We recommend using a tripod.
It cannot be set to [ ] in the following cases:
When recording using [Bracket]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [Simultaneous record w/o filter] of [Filter Settings] is set to [ON]
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode (When taking pictures in Self Shot Mode, you can set the Self-timer in
[Countdown] (→57))
During motion picture recording
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
130
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting
Automatically
(Bracket Recording)
Recording mode:
You can take multiple pictures while automatically adjusting a setting by pressing the
shutter button.
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Rec] → [Bracket] → [Bracket Type]
(Exposure Bracket)
Press the shutter button to perform recording while adjusting
the exposure. (→131)
*
(Aperture Bracket)
Press the shutter button to perform recording while adjusting
the aperture. (→132)
(Focus Bracket)
Press the shutter button to perform recording while adjusting
the focus position. (→132)
(White Balance Bracket)
Press the shutter button once to take three pictures with
different white balance settings automatically. (→109)
*
Available in Aperture-Priority AE Mode or when the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO] in Manual
Exposure Mode.
2
Press to select [More settings] and then press [MENU/SET]
• For information on [More settings], refer to the page that describes each function.
• Press the shutter button halfway to exit the menu.
3
Focus on the subject and take a picture
• When Exposure Bracket is selected, the bracket display flashes until all of the
pictures you have set are taken. If you change the bracket settings or turn off
the camera before all of the pictures you have set are taken, the camera restarts
recording from the first picture.
To cancel [Bracket]
Select [OFF] in step
1
.
131
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting Automatically (Bracket Recording)
Bracket recording is disabled in the following cases.
In Self Shot Mode
[Glistening Water]/[Glittering Illuminations]/[Handheld Night Shot]/[Soft Image of a Flower]
(Scene Guide Mode)
[Rough Monochrome]/[Silky Monochrome]/[Miniature Effect]/[Soft Focus]/[Star Filter]/[Sunshine]
(Creative Control Mode)
When recording using the flash (except for White Balance Bracket)
When recording motion pictures
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
Exposure Bracket
About [More settings] (step
2
in (→130))
[Step]
Sets the number of pictures to be taken and the exposure compensation
range.
[
] (Takes three pictures with an interval of 1/3 EV) to [ ]
(Takes seven pictures with an interval of 1 EV)
[Sequence] Sets the order in which pictures are taken.
[Single Shot Setting]
*
[ ]: Takes one picture each time you press the shutter button.
[
]: Takes all the pictures set to be taken when you press the shutter
button once.
*
Not available for burst recording. When using burst recording, if you press and hold the shutter
button, recording will be performed continuously until a specified number of pictures are taken.
[Step]: [ ], [Sequence]: [0/+/–]
1st picture 2nd picture 3rd picture
±0 EV –1/3 EV +1/3 EV
When taking pictures using Exposure Bracket after setting the Exposure Compensation value, the
pictures taken are based on the selected Exposure Compensation value.
132
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking Pictures While Adjusting a Setting Automatically (Bracket Recording)
Aperture Bracket
Recording mode:
About [More settings] (step
2
in (→130))
[Image Count]
[3], [5]: Takes a specified number of pictures with different aperture
values within the range based on the initial aperture value.
[ALL]: Takes pictures using all aperture values.
• When using burst recording, if you press and hold the shutter button, recording will be
performed until a specified number of pictures are taken.
Example:
2 2.8 4 5.6 8 11
When the initial position is set to F4:
first picture, second picture, third picture... seventh picture
Focus Bracket
About [More settings] (step
2
in (→130))
[Step] Sets the interval between focus positions.
[Image Count]
*
Sets the number of pictures to be taken.
[Sequence]
[0/–/+]: Takes pictures with different focus positions within the range
based on the initial focus position.
[0/+]: Takes pictures with different focus positions toward the far side
based on the initial focus position.
*
Not available for burst recording. When using burst recording, if you press and hold the shutter
button, recording will be performed continuously until a specified number of pictures are taken.
[Sequence]: Example when [0/–/+] is selected [Sequence]: Example when [0/+] is selected
Close-up
Infinity
first picture, second picture... fifth picture...
Pictures taken with Focus Bracket are displayed as a set of group pictures. (→166)
133
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking pictures automatically at set intervals
[Time Lapse Shot]
Recording mode:
You can preset data such as recording start time and time lapse to take still pictures
automatically. This setting is convenient for taking pictures at constant intervals for
landscape scenes, observation of the gradual changes in animals/plants, and other
applications. The pictures are recorded as a set of group pictures (→166). When [Time
Lapse Video] in the [Playback] menu is used, you can create a motion picture. (→220)
Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→28)
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Rec] → [Time Lapse Shot]
[Start Time] [Now] Starts the recording by fully-pressing the shutter
button.
[Start Time Set] Any time up to 23 hours 59 minutes ahead can be
set.
Press to select the item (hour and/or
minute), and to set the start time, and
press [MENU/SET]
[Shooting Interval] /
[Image Count]
The recording interval and the number of pictures can be set.
: Select the item (minute/second/number of pictures)
: Setting
[MENU/SET]: Set
• The camera may not be able to record using the preset interval and number of
pictures to be recorded under some recording conditions.
2
Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
3
Press the shutter button fully
• The recording starts automatically.
• During recording standby, the camera turns off automatically when no operation
is performed for a preset interval. The [Time Lapse Shot] recording will continue
even if the camera is turned off, and the camera is automatically turned on at the
recording start time. If you want to turn on the camera manually, press the shutter
button halfway.
• Operations during recording standby (The camera is turned on)
Operation
Touch
operation
Description
[Fn1]
Displays a selection screen that lets you pause or stop the
recording
Displays a selection screen that lets you resume or stop the
recording (during pause)
134
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Taking pictures automatically at set intervals [Time Lapse Shot]
4
Select the motion picture creation method
• [Rec Format]: [MP4]
[Rec Quality] Sets the picture quality of the motion picture.
[Frame Rate]
Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you
can create a more seamless animation.
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence.
[REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording.
5
Press to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
• You can also create a motion picture using [Time Lapse Video] in the [Playback]
menu. (→220)
This function is not intended for application-specific systems (monitoring cameras).
When using zoom, the camera could tilt when the lens barrel extends. Make sure to secure the
camera in place with a tripod or by other means.
[Time Lapse Shot] is paused in the following cases:
When the remaining battery power runs out
Turning the camera off
If this occurs during [Time Lapse Shot] recording, you can restart the operation by replacing the
battery or card in the pause state and turning the camera on. (Note, however, that the pictures
recorded after restarting the operation are saved as a separate set of group pictures.) When you
replace the battery or card, turn the camera off.
We recommend using auto focus for time lapse recording in cases where a long [Shooting
Interval] is set and the camera will turn off automatically between shots.
Motion pictures whose recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds cannot be created.
If using an SDHC Memory Card, you will not be able to create motion pictures with a file size
greater than 4 GB. With an SDXC Memory Card, you can create motion pictures with a file size
greater than 4 GB.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
135
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Creating stop motion animation
[Stop Motion Animation]
Recording mode:
You can stitch still pictures to create stop motion animation.
Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→28)
• Still pictures that were captured using frame-by-frame recording are grouped into a
single picture group. (→166)
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Rec] → [Stop Motion Animation]
[Auto Shooting] [ON] Takes pictures automatically at a set recording interval.
[OFF] Takes pictures manually, one frame at a time.
[Shooting Interval] (Only when [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON])
Set the interval used for [Auto Shooting].
2
Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
3
Press to select [New] and press
[MENU/SET]
4
Press the shutter button fully
• Up to 9,999 frames can be recorded.
5
Move the subject to decide on the
composition
• Repeat the recording of still pictures in the same way.
• When you turn off the camera during recording, a message to restart recording
will appear when you turn on the camera. To start recording from the next still
picture, select [Yes].
How to create stop motion animation effectively
Up to two previously recorded pictures are displayed on the recording screen. Check this screen as
a guideline for determining the amount of required motion.
You can press [ ] (Playback) button to check the recorded pictures. Press [ ] button to delete
unnecessary pictures. To return to the recording screen, press [
] (Playback) button again.
136
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation]
6
Touch [ ] to end the recording
• You can also end the recording by selecting [Stop
Motion Animation] in the [Rec] menu, and then
pressing [MENU/SET].
• When [Auto Shooting] is set to [ON], select [End] on
the confirmation screen. (If you select [Pause], press
the shutter button fully to resume recording.)
7
Select a method to create a stop motion animation
• [Rec Format]: [MP4]
[Rec Quality] Sets the picture quality of the motion picture.
[Frame Rate]
Set the number of frames per second. When you set a higher number, you
can create a more seamless animation.
[Sequence]
[NORMAL]: Stitches the still pictures in the recording sequence.
[REVERSE]: Stitches the still pictures in the reverse order of recording.
8
Press to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
• You can also create a stop motion animation using [Stop Motion Video] in the
[Playback] menu. (→221)
Adding pictures to an already recorded stop motion animation group
When you select [Additional] in step
3
, group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion
Animation] are displayed. Select a set of group pictures and press [MENU/SET]. Then,
select [Yes] on the confirmation screen.
137
SQW0721
4K Photo and Drive Settings
Creating stop motion animation [Stop Motion Animation]
[Auto Shooting] may not be performed according to the preset interval because recording could
take time under some recording conditions, such as when pictures are taken using a flash.
Motion pictures whose recording time exceeds 29 minutes and 59 seconds cannot be created.
If using an SDHC Memory Card, you will not be able to create motion pictures with a file size
greater than 4 GB. With an SDXC Memory Card, you can create motion pictures with a file size
greater than 4 GB.
You cannot select only one recorded still picture using [Additional].
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
[Auto Shooting] in [Stop Motion Animation] cannot be used in the following case:
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
138
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter
Recording mode:
Automatically detects and prevents jitter.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [Stabilizer]
(Normal)
Corrects vertical and horizontal jitter.
(Panning)
Corrects vertical jitter. This setting is ideal for panning (technique of recording a
subject by matching the camera movement with the movement of a subject going
in a specific direction).
[OFF] [Stabilizer] does not work.
To prevent jitter
If a warning is displayed about jitter, use [Stabilizer], a tripod, or [Self
Timer].
Shutter speed will be slower particularly in the following cases. Keep
the camera still from the moment the shutter button is pressed until
the picture appears on the screen. We recommend using a tripod.
[Slow Sync.]
[Slow Sync./Red-Eye]
[Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape],
[Artistic Nightscape], [Glittering Illuminations], [Clear Night Portrait]
(Scene Guide Mode)
When the shutter speed is slowed
60
p
139
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Correcting jitter
When you use a tripod, we recommend setting [Stabilizer] to [OFF].
[Stabilizer] cannot be used by selecting [ ] (Normal) in Panorama Shot Mode.
In the following cases, the [Stabilizer] will switch to [ ] (Normal), even if it is set to [ ]
(Panning):
During motion picture recording
When 4K Photo function has been set
When recording using [Post Focus]
[Stabilizer] cannot be used when recording high-speed motion pictures.
The 5-axis Hybrid Image Stabilizer function automatically functions while recording motion
pictures. This corrects jitters that occur in 5 directions during motion picture recording, namely the
vertical direction, horizontal direction, rotation axis, vertical rotation, and horizontal rotation.
The recording range may become narrower.
The 5-axis Hybrid Image Stabilizer function is not available when recording motion pictures for
which [Rec Quality] is set to either [4K/100M/30p] or [4K/100M/24p].
Cases where the stabilizer function may be ineffective:
When there is a lot of jitter
When the zoom magnification is high (also in the Digital Zoom range)
When taking pictures while following a moving subject
When the shutter speed becomes slower to take pictures indoors or in dark places
The panning effect by selecting [ ] is not fully achieved in the following cases:
Bright summer days or other bright locations
When the shutter speed is higher than 1/100 seconds
When the motion of a subject is slow and the speed with which the camera is moved is too slow
(a nice background blur is not achieved)
When the camera is not adequately tracking the motion of a subject
140
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
Zoom types and use
The zoom ratio changes when the picture size is changed.
Optical Zoom
Recording mode:
You can zoom in without degrading the picture quality.
Maximum magnification: 3x
This function is not available in the following case:
When recording with [Macro Zoom]
Extended optical zoom
Recording mode:
This function works when picture sizes with [ ] have been selected in [Picture Size]
(→174). Extended optical zoom allows you to zoom in using a higher zoom ratio than
Optical Zoom, without degrading the picture quality. The maximum zoom ratio varies
depending on the picture size.
Maximum magnification: 6x
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Toy Effect], [Toy Pop] (Creative Control Mode)
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON]
When [iHDR] is set to [ON]
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When recording with [Macro Zoom]
During motion picture recording
141
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
To increase the zoom ratio further, the following zoom can be used in combination.
[i.Zoom]
Recording mode:
You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to increase the zoom ratio up
to 2x higher than the original zoom ratio with limited deterioration of picture quality.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [i.Zoom]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
When [Picture Size] is set to [S], the zoom ratio can be increased to up to 1.5x the original zoom
ratio.
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop] (Creative Control Mode)
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
During [Macro Zoom] recording
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [iHandheld Night Shot] is set to [ON]
When [iHDR] is set to [ON]
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
142
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
[Digital Zoom]
Recording mode:
Zoom 4x further than Optical/Extended optical zoom.
Note that, with Digital Zoom, enlarging will decrease picture quality.
[Rec] / [Motion Picture] → [Digital Zoom]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
When [Digital Zoom] is used simultaneously with [i.Zoom], you can only increase the zoom ratio
up to 2x.
When using [Digital Zoom], we recommend using a tripod and the self-timer (→129) for taking
pictures.
The AF area is largely displayed at the center in the Digital Zoom range.
This function is not available in the following cases:
When [Live View Mode] is set to [ECO 30fps] (setting at the time of purchase)
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Impressive Art], [Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording with [High Speed Video]
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
The illustration is an example of when using Optical Zoom, [i.Zoom], and [Digital Zoom] in Program AE
Mode.
Focus range
Optical Zoom range
i.Zoom range
Digital Zoom range
Current zoom position (Focal lengths the same as those of a 35 mm film camera)
143
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Using Zoom
Using the zoom by performing touch operations (Touch zoom)
1
Touch [ ]
2
Touch [ ]
The slide bar is displayed.
3
Perform zoom operations by dragging the slide
bar
The zoom speed varies depending on the touched position.
[ ] / [ ] Slow zooming
[
] / [ ]
Fast zooming
Touch [
] again to end touch zoom operations.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
When [High Speed Video] is set
When recording using [4K Live Cropping]
144
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures with flash
Recording mode:
Open/Close the built-in flash
To open the flash
Slide the flash open lever.
Be careful when opening the flash as the flash will
jump out.
To close the flash
Press the flash until it clicks.
Be careful not to catch a finger or any other part of
your body or any object when you close the flash.
Forcibly closing the flash can damage the camera.
Be sure to close the built-in flash when not in use.
The flash setting is fixed to [
] (Forced Flash Off)
while the flash is closed.
The flash is fixed to [ ] (Forced Flash Off) in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When using the electronic shutter
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
When a picture effect in [Filter Effect] of [Filter Settings] is set
145
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Taking pictures with flash
The available flash range
Edges of a picture may become slightly dark if using flash at short distances without using
zoom (close to max. Wide). This may be remedied by using a little zoom.
Max. Wide Max. Tele
Approx. 0.5 m - 12.1 m (1.6 feet - 40 feet) Approx. 0.3 m - 6.0 m (0.98 feet - 20 feet)
• These ranges are obtained, the ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO], and [ISO Limit Set] is
set to [OFF].
Avoid doing the following, as the heat or light could cause deformation or discoloration.
Putting the flash close to objects
Covering the flash with your hand as it is firing
Closing the flash as it is firing
Do not close the flash immediately after the preliminary flash is operated prior to taking pictures for
Forced ON/Red-Eye Reduction and other flash settings. If you close the flash immediately, it will
cause a malfunction.
Flash charging may take time if battery is low or if using flash repeatedly. When the flash is being
charged, the flash icon flashes red, and you cannot take a picture even when you fully press the
shutter button.
146
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Changing Flash Mode
Recording mode:
Set the flash to match the recording.
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Mode]
: [Forced Flash On]
: [Forced On/Red-Eye]
Always takes pictures using the flash.
Ideal for taking pictures with a backlight or when a
subject is located under bright lighting such as a
fluorescent light.
: [Slow Sync.]
: [Slow Sync./Red-Eye]
When taking pictures against a dark background landscape,
this feature will slow the shutter speed when the flash is
activated.
Ideal for taking pictures of people against a nightscape.
Using a slower speed can cause motion blur. We
recommend using a tripod.
The flash is activated twice.
The interval between the first and second flash is longer when [ ] or [ ] is set.
The subject should not move until the second flash is activated.
• The red-eye reduction effect varies depending on the subject and is affected by factors
such as distance from the subject and whether the subject is looking at the camera
during the preliminary flash. In some cases, red-eye reduction may be negligible.
Shutter speeds for each flash mode
Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds)
1/60
*
1
- 1/4000
Flash Mode Shutter speed (seconds)
1 - 1/16000
60
*
2
- 1/16000
*
1
The shutter speed is set to 60 seconds in Shutter-Priority AE Mode and to T (Time) in Manual
Exposure Mode.
*
2
The shutter speed is set to T (Time) in Manual Exposure Mode.
• In Intelligent Auto Mode ([ ] or [ ]), the shutter speed changes depending on the
detected scene.
Setting the Flash Functions
147
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Setting the Flash Functions
Flash settings for each Recording mode (○: Available, –: Not available)
Recording mode
Program AE Mode
Aperture-Priority AE Mode
Shutter-Priority AE Mode
Manual Exposure Mode
Scene Guide
Mode
(●: Default
settings)
[Clear Portrait]
[Silky Skin]
[Backlit Softness]
[Clear in Backlight]
[Relaxing Tone]
[Sweet Child’s Face]
[Distinct Scenery]
[Bright Blue Sky]
[Romantic Sunset Glow]
[Vivid Sunset Glow]
[Glistening Water]
[Clear Nightscape]
[Cool Night Sky]
[Warm Glowing Nightscape]
[Artistic Nightscape]
[Glittering Illuminations]
[Handheld Night Shot]
[Clear Night Portrait]
[Soft Image of a Flower]
[Appetizing Food]
[Cute Dessert]
[Freeze Animal Motion]
[Clear Sports Shot]
[Monochrome]
For details about flash settings in Intelligent Auto Mode ([ ] or [ ]), refer to (→51).
The Scene Guide Mode flash setting is returned to the initial value with each change of scene.
148
SQW0721
Stabilizer, Zoom and Flash
Setting the Flash Functions
Setting the 2nd curtain sync
Recording mode:
2nd curtain sync is a recording method in which the flash fires just before the shutter
closes when you take a picture of a moving subject (such as a car) using the flash with a
slow shutter speed.
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Synchro]
[1ST] 1st curtain sync is the normal recording method when
using the flash.
[2ND] The light source is captured in back of the subject and
this produces a picture that is vibrant and lively.
If you set to [2ND], [2nd] will be displayed in the flash icon on the screen.
When a fast shutter speed is set, the [Flash Synchro] effect may not be sufficiently achieved.
When [2ND] is set, you cannot set the flash setting to [ ] or [ ].
Adjusting the flash output
Recording mode:
Adjust the flash output if a picture taken using the flash is too bright or too dark.
[Rec] → [Flash] → [Flash Adjust.]
1
Press to set the flash output and press [MENU/SET]
Settings: –2 EV to +2 EV (unit: 1/3 EV)
When you do not want to adjust the intensity of the flash, select [±0 EV].
When the intensity of the flash is adjusted, [+] or [-] is displayed on the flash icon.
149
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
Recording mode:
You can record full high-definition quality images that comply with the AVCHD standard,
as well as motion pictures recorded in MP4. You can also record a 4K motion picture in
MP4. (→151)
Audio is recorded in stereo.
1
Press the motion picture button to start
recording
Recording state indicator
Elapsed recording time
Remaining recording time
• Recording of motion picture appropriate for each
motion picture mode is possible.
• Immediately release the motion picture button after
pressing it.
• While you are recording motion pictures, the recording
status indicator (red) will flash.
With recording in a quiet environment, the
sound of aperture, focus and other actions may
be recorded in motion pictures. This is not a
malfunction.
The focus operation during recording of motion
pictures can be set to [OFF] in [Continuous AF].
(→153)
2
Press the motion picture button again to
end recording
About operation sound when recording ends
If the operation sound of the motion picture button pressed to end recording bothers you, try the
following:
Record the motion picture about three seconds longer, and then divide the last part of the motion
picture using [Video Divide] (→220) in the [Playback] menu.
150
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
If the surrounding temperature is high, or a motion picture is recorded continuously, [ ] is
displayed and recording may be stopped halfway through. Wait until the camera cools down.
If Extended optical zoom is used before pressing the motion picture button, these settings will be
cleared, and the recordable area will be changed significantly.
If the aspect ratio is different for still pictures and motion pictures, the angle of view will change
when starting to record a motion picture.
When you set [Rec Area] to [
], the angle of view setting used for recording motion pictures is
displayed.
Note that if you perform operations such as zoom, using buttons or dials, while recording a motion
picture, operation noise may be recorded.
The zoom speed will be slower than normal during motion picture recording.
Depending on the type of the card, the card access indication may appear for a while after
recording motion pictures. This is not a malfunction.
ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO] (for motion pictures) while a motion picture is being recorded.
The below-mentioned motion picture recording modes are set in the following cases:
Selected Scene Guide Mode
Recording mode at the time of
recording motion pictures
[Clear in Backlight] Portrait Mode
[Clear Nightscape], [Artistic Nightscape],
[Handheld Night Shot], [Clear Night Portrait]
Low Light Mode
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Glistening Water], [Glittering Illuminations], [Soft Image of a Flower] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter], [Sunshine] (Creative
Control Mode)
When recording using [Post Focus]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
151
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
Setting the format, picture size and recording frame rate
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Motion Picture] → [Rec Format]
[AVCHD] This is a data format suitable for playback on high-definition TVs.
[MP4]
This data format is suited for playing back motion pictures on a computer and other
such devices.
2
Use to select [Rec Quality] and press [MENU/SET]
When [AVCHD] is selected
[Rec Quality] Picture size
Recording frame rate
Sensor output Bit rate
[FHD/28M/60p]
*
1
1920×1080 60p 60 fps Approx. 28 Mbps
[FHD/17M/60i] 1920×1080 60i 60 fps Approx. 17 Mbps
[FHD/24M/30p] 1920×1080 60i 30 fps Approx. 24 Mbps
[FHD/24M/24p] 1920×1080 24p 24 fps Approx. 24 Mbps
When [MP4] is selected
[Rec Quality] Picture size
Recording frame rate
Sensor output Bit rate
[4K/100M/30p]
*
2
3840×2160 30p 30 fps Approx. 100 Mbps
[4K/100M/24p]
*
2
3840×2160 24p 24 fps Approx. 100 Mbps
[FHD/28M/60p] 1920×1080 60p 60 fps Approx. 28 Mbps
[FHD/20M/30p] 1920×1080 30p 30 fps Approx. 20 Mbps
[HD/10M/30p] 1280×720 30p 30 fps Approx. 10 Mbps
*
1
AVCHD Progressive
*
2
4K motion pictures
152
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
• The quality becomes higher when the number of bit rate gets bigger. This unit uses the
“VBR” recording method, and the bit rate is changed automatically depending on the
subject to record. Therefore, the recording time is shortened when a subject with fast
movement is recorded.
• 4K motion picture cannot be set when using [Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode).
• To record 4K motion pictures, use a UHS Speed Class 3 card. (→25)
• When you record 4K motion pictures, the angle of view will be narrower than motion
pictures of other sizes.
• To ensure highly accurate focus, 4K motion pictures are recorded at reduced Auto
Focus speeds. It may be difficult to focus on the subject with Auto Focus, but this is not
a malfunction.
• Limitations on continuous recording (→27)
About the compatibility of the recorded motion pictures
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] or [MP4] may be played back with poor picture or
sound quality or playback may not be possible even when played back with equipment
compatible with these formats. Also, the recording information may not be displayed
properly.
• When you play back and import motion pictures recorded with [FHD/28M/60p],
[FHD/24M/30p], or [FHD/24M/24p] in [AVCHD] using a device other than this unit, a
compatible Blu-ray disc recorder or PC installed with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software
(→274) is required.
• For details on motion pictures recorded with [4K/100M/30p] or [4K/100M/24p] in the
[MP4] format, refer to “Enjoying 4K motion pictures” (→268).
153
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Motion Picture/4K Motion Picture
Adjusting the focus while recording motion pictures
([Continuous AF])
Recording mode:
Focusing varies depending on the setting of focus and the setting of [Continuous AF] in
the [Motion Picture] menu.
[Motion Picture] → [Continuous AF]
Focus setting [Continuous AF] Setting
[AFS]/[AFF]/[AFC]
(→88)
[ON]
Allow the focus to be constantly adjusted
automatically while recording motion pictures.
[OFF]
Fix focus position at the start of motion picture
recording.
[MF] (→100) [ON] / [OFF] Allow the focus to be adjusted manually.
When [AFS/AFF/AFC] is set to [AFS], [AFF], or [AFC], the camera will refocus if the shutter button
is pressed halfway while recording motion pictures.
When Auto Focus is activated while you are recording motion pictures, the focusing operation
sound may be recorded under some conditions. If you want to suppress this sound, we
recommend taking pictures after setting [Continuous AF] to [OFF] in the [Motion Picture] menu.
When using zoom while recording motion pictures, it may take some time to focus.
[Continuous AF] does not work while [Pull Focus] in [Snap Movie] is in operation.
This function is not available in the following cases:
While [Pull Focus] in [Snap Movie] is in operation.
When recording using [4K Live Cropping]
154
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Pan or zoom while recording with the camera in a
fixed position
[4K Live Cropping]
Recording mode:
By cropping your motion picture down from the 4K angle of view to Full High Definition,
you can record a motion picture that pans and zooms in/out while leaving the camera in a
fixed position.
• Hold the camera firmly in place while recording.
• A motion picture will be recorded at [FHD/20M/30p] under [MP4].
Pan Zoom in
• When you want to zoom in/out, set different angles of view for the cropping start and
end frames. For example, to zoom in, set a larger angle of view for the start frame and
a smaller angle of view for the end frame.
1
Set mode dial to [ ]
2
Set the menu (→42)
[Motion Picture] → [4K Live Cropping]
Settings: [40SEC] / [20SEC] / [OFF]
• The angle of view narrows.
155
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Pan or zoom while recording with the camera in a fixed position [4K Live Cropping]
3
Set the crop start frame
Crop start frame
• When making settings for the first time, a crop start
frame of size 1920×1080 is displayed. (After setting
the crop start frame and end frame, the start frame
and end frame that you set immediately before will be
displayed.)
• The camera will remember the frame position and size
even when the camera is turned off.
SetSet
SizeSize
ResetReset
StartStart
Operation Touch operation Description
Touch Moves the frame
Pinch out /
Pinch in
Enlarges/reduces the frame
(The range of settings allowed is from 1920×1080 to
3840×2160.)
[DISP.] [Reset]
Returns the position of the frame to the center and its
size to the default setting.
[MENU/SET] [Set] Decides the position and size of the frame
4
Repeat step
3
, and then set the crop end
frame
Crop end frame
• The setting of [AF Mode] switches to [ ] (Face/Eye
Detection). (The Eye Detection cannot be used.)
ResetReset
EndEnd
SetSet
SizeSize
5
Press the motion picture button (or
shutter button) to start recording
Elapsed recording time
Set operating time
• Immediately release the motion picture button (or
shutter button) after pressing it.
• When the set operating time has elapsed, recording
automatically ends. To end recording midway, press
the motion picture button (or the shutter button) again.
156
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Pan or zoom while recording with the camera in a fixed position [4K Live Cropping]
Changing the position and size of a crop frame
Press [Fn1] button while the recording screen is displayed, and perform steps
3
and
4
.
To cancel [4K Live Cropping] recording
Set [OFF] in step
2
.
[4K Live Cropping] recording cannot be performed when [High Speed Video] is set.
Focus is adjusted and fixed in the crop start frame.
[Continuous AF] is set to [OFF].
[Metering Mode] will be [Multi Metering].
157
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Taking still pictures while a motion picture is being
recorded
Recording mode:
1
Press the shutter button fully during the
motion picture recording
• Up to 30 pictures can be recorded.
• Simultaneous recording indicator is displayed while
recording still pictures.
• Recording with the Touch Shutter function (→40) is
also available.
The aspect ratio of a still picture is fixed to [16:9].
Takes a still picture using [Picture Size] [S] (2M). The picture quality may be different to [S] (2M) of
standard pictures.
Only pictures in JPEG file format are recorded when [Quality] is set to [ ], [ ], or [ ].
([Quality] is used with the [
] setting when [ ] is set.)
This function is not available in the following cases:
When [Rec Format] is set to [MP4], [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/100M/30p] or [4K/100M/24p]
When [Snap Movie] is set to [ON]
158
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Snap Movies
Recording mode:
You can specify the recording time in advance and record motion pictures casually like
you take snapshots. The function also allows you to shift a focus at the start of recording
and add fade in/out effects in advance.
• Motion pictures will be recorded with [FHD/20M/30p] in [MP4].
• Using the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App”, you can combine motion
pictures recorded with the camera. Music can be added and various editing operations
can be performed when you combine them. In addition, you can send the combined
motion picture to a web service. (→240)
[Motion Picture] → [Snap Movie] → [ON]
• Press the shutter button halfway to exit the menu.
1
Press the motion picture button to start
recording
Elapsed recording time
Set recording time
• Immediately release the motion picture button after
pressing it.
• You cannot stop motion picture recording in the
middle. The recording will stop automatically when the
set recording time has elapsed.
Deactivating Snap Movie
Set [Snap Movie] to [OFF].
159
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Snap Movies
Changing the settings
[Motion Picture] → [Snap Movie] → [SET]
[Record time] Sets the recording time of motion pictures.
[Pull Focus] Allows dramatic imaging expression by shifting focus gradually at the start of
recording.
[Fade] Adds a fade-in (gradual appearance) effect to an image and audio as recording
starts or adds a fade-out (gradual disappearance) effect to them as recording
ends.
[WHITE-IN] / [WHITE-OUT]:
Adds a fade-in or fade-out effect that uses a white screen.
[BLACK-IN] / [BLACK-OUT]:
Adds a fade-in or fade-out effect that uses a black screen.
[COLOR-IN] / [COLOR-OUT]:
Adds an effect that fades in from black-and-white to color or an effect that fades
out from color to black-and-white. Audio will be recorded normally.
[OFF]
Motion pictures recorded with [WHITE-IN] or [BLACK-IN] are displayed as all-white or all-black
thumbnails in Playback Mode.
If you assign [Snap Movie] to [Fn Button Set] in [Custom] menu (→46), you can display a screen
that lets you switch [Snap Movie] between [ON]/[OFF] by pressing the assigned function button.
If you press [DISP.] button while the screen is displayed, you can change the settings for Snap
Movie.
[Snap Movie] will be set to [OFF] when you connect to Wi-Fi with [Remote Shooting & View].
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
When [4K PHOTO] is set
When [4K Live Cropping] is set
During [High Speed Video] recording
160
SQW0721
Recording motion pictures
Recording Snap Movies
Setting up [Pull Focus]
Set the frames that specify the positions where the [Pull
Focus] starts (first position) and stops (second position).
Touch operation
Touch a subject (first position), drag your finger to the desired location (second position),
and release the finger.
To cancel the frame settings, touch [ ].
Button operation
Assign [AF Mode] to a function button ([Fn1] - [Fn3]) (→46)
Press the function button that [AF Mode] has assigned to at step
Press to move the frame, and press [MENU/SET] (First position)
If you press [DISP.] button before pressing [MENU/SET], the frame will return to the center.
Repeat step (Second position)
To cancel the frame settings, press [MENU/SET].
A greater effect can be achieved by creating a striking contrast of focus between the start
and end positions, for example by shifting focus from the background to foreground, or vice
versa.
After setting focus, try to keep the distance between the subject and the camera constant.
When the camera fails to set the frame, it returns to the first position.
When [Pull Focus] is set to [ON]
Auto Focus Mode will be switched to [
], a setting specially designed for [Pull Focus].
If you take a picture, the Auto Focus operation [
] will take place at the first frame position.
Even when [Metering Mode] (→175) is set to [ ] (Spot), the spot metering target does not move
with focus. The target is fixed at the start position (first position) of [Pull Focus].
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Manual Focus
When using the Digital Zoom
161
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing your pictures
1
Press [ ] (Playback) button
2
Press to select a picture to be
displayed
• When you press and hold , the pictures are
displayed one after another.
• Pictures can also be forwarded or rewound by rotating
the rear dial or dragging the screen horizontally (→39).
• If you keep your finger touching the left or right edge of
the screen after scrolling the pictures, the pictures will
continue to be scrolled. (The pictures are displayed in
a reduced size.)
Sending pictures to the WEB services
If you press while a single picture is being displayed, you can send the picture to the WEB service
quickly. (→252)
Ending Playback
Press [
] (Playback) button again or press the Motion picture button.
The Playback can also be ended by pressing the shutter button halfway.
The playback screen appears if the camera is turned on while pressing [ ] (Playback) button.
When [Lens Retraction] is set to [ON], the lens barrel is retracted after approx. 15 seconds as the
camera is switched to the playback screen from the recording screen.
This camera is compliant with the unified DCF (Design rule for Camera File system) standard
formulated by the Japan Electronics and Information Technology Industries Association (JEITA),
and with Exif (Exchangeable image file format).
Files that are not DCF-compliant cannot be played back.
It may not be possible to properly play back pictures taken using other cameras on this unit or it
may not be possible to use the functions of this unit for those pictures.
162
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing motion pictures
This unit was designed to play motion pictures using the AVCHD and MP4 formats.
• Motion pictures are displayed with the motion picture icon ([ ]).
1
Press to start playback
Motion picture recording time
• Touching [ ] in the middle of the screen allows you
to play back motion pictures.
• Motion pictures recorded with [Snap Movie] are played
back automatically.
• Some information will not be displayed for motion
pictures recorded in [AVCHD].
Operations during motion picture playback
Operation Touch operation Description
Play/pause
Fast rewind
*
1
Single-frame rewind
*
2
(while paused)
Stop
Fast forward
*
1
Single-frame forward (while paused)
/
Volume down / Volume up
*
1
The fast forward or rewind speed increases if you press again.
*
2
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] are rewound frame by frame approximately every
0.5 seconds.
Operations during automatic Snap Movie playback
Playback from the beginning
Returning to the previous picture
Scrolling to the next picture
• If you touch the screen, automatic playback will stop.
Motion pictures can be viewed on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (→274).
163
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing motion pictures
Capturing still pictures from motion pictures
Save a scene from a motion picture as a still picture.
1
Display the picture that you want to capture as a still
picture by pressing to pause a motion picture being
played back on the camera
If you press while paused, you can make finer adjustments
to the positions in a motion picture.
2
Press [MENU/SET]
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
The still picture is saved with aspect ratio of [16:9] and [Quality]
of [
]. The picture size varies depending on the motion picture
being played back.
[Rec Quality] [Picture Size]
[4K] [M] (8M)
[FHD], [HD] [S] (2M)
The picture quality becomes slightly lower depending on the [Rec Quality] setting of the original
motion picture.
When a still picture captured from a motion picture is played back, [ ] is displayed.
If you want to capture a still picture from a motion picture while the camera is connected to a TV
with the HDMI micro cable, set [VIERA Link] of [TV Connection] in the [Setup] menu to [OFF].
164
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Switching the Playback Method
Zooming in and viewing “Playback Zoom”
1
Move the zoom lever toward T side
Current zoom position
Each time you move the zoom lever toward the T side, the
magnification increases through four levels: 1x, 2x, 4x, 8x, and
16x.
To reduce zoom → Move the zoom lever toward W side.
You can also enlarge/reduce the image by pinching out/pinching
in (→39) on the part you want to enlarge/reduce.
You can move the enlarged part by pressing
of the
cursor button or dragging the screen. (→39)
You can also zoom in by quickly touching the touch screen twice.
(If the display was enlarged, it returns to the same magnification
ratio.)
You can forward or rewind a picture while maintaining the same
zoom magnification and zoom position by rotating the rear dial
during Playback Zoom.
Viewing a list of pictures “Multi Playback”
1
Move the zoom lever toward W side
Move the zoom lever toward the W side and you can switch the
display methods in the following order: 1-picture screen (full-
screen) → 12-picture screen → 30-picture screen → Calendar
screen. (Move the lever to the T side to return.)
It is possible to switch the playback screen by touching the
following icons.
[
]: 1-picture screen [
]: 12-picture screen
[
]: 30-picture screen [
]: Calendar screen
The screen can be switched gradually by dragging the screen up
or down.
When you select a picture using the cursor button and press
[MENU/SET] on the 12-picture or 30-picture screen, the selected
picture is displayed on the 1-picture screen (full-screen).
Pictures displayed with [!] cannot be played back.
165
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Switching the Playback Method
Viewing pictures by their recording date “Calendar Playback”
1
Move the zoom lever toward the W side to display the
calendar screen
2
Use to select recording date and press
[MENU/SET]
Selected date
Pictures are displayed in a 12-picture screen.
Turn the zoom lever toward the W side to return to the Calendar
screen display.
MONSUN TUEWEDTHU FRI S AT
The recording date of the picture selected in the playback screen becomes the date selected
when the Calendar screen is first displayed.
You can display the calendar between January 2000 to December 2099.
Pictures taken without clock settings are displayed with the date January 1st, 2016.
Pictures taken with destination settings made in [World Time] are displayed in the calendar screen
using the appropriate date for the destination’s time zone.
166
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
You can consecutively play back multiple pictures in a group or play back group pictures
one by one.
[
]: Group pictures recorded consecutively by setting the
burst speed to [SH] (→127)
Group picture saved using [4K PHOTO Bulk Saving]
(→215)
[ ]: Group pictures recorded using Focus Bracket (→132)
[ ]: Group pictures recorded using [Time Lapse Shot]
(→133)
[ ]: Group pictures recorded using [Stop Motion
Animation] (→135)
15
pic.
15
pic.
• You can delete or edit pictures in group units. (For example, if you delete one of
pictures in a group, all pictures in that group will be deleted.)
Pictures will not be grouped if they are recorded without setting [Clock Set].
Playing back group pictures consecutively
1
Press
The same operation can be performed by touching the group picture icon ([ ], [ ],
[
]).
Operations during continuous playback
Continuous playback / Pause Stop
Fast rewind playback Fast forward playback
Returning to the previous picture
(while paused)
Scrolling to the next picture
(while paused)
Viewing group pictures
167
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Viewing group pictures
Playing back group pictures one by one
1
Press
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ] / [ ] /
[
] / [ ].
15
pic.
15
pic.
2
Use to scroll through the pictures
[ ]: When you play back group pictures one by one, the option settings are displayed.
After you select [Burst Play] (or [Sequential Play]), select one of the following playback methods.
[From the first picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the first picture in a
group.
[From the current picture]: Play back the group pictures consecutively from the picture currently
played back.
Pressing
again or touching [ ] will return you to the normal playback screen.
You can use the same operations for pictures stored in a group as in normal still picture
playback. (Multi Playback, Playback Zoom, deletion of pictures, etc.)
168
SQW0721
Playing Back and Editing Pictures
Deleting pictures
Deleted pictures cannot be recovered.
[Delete Single]
1
Press [ ] button to delete displayed picture
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
2
Use to select [Delete Single] and press [MENU/SET]
To delete multiple (up to 100
*
)/To delete all pictures
*
A picture group (→166) is handled as 1 picture. (All the pictures in the selected picture
group are deleted.)
1
Press [ ] button while viewing a picture
2
Use to select [Delete Multi]/[Delete All] and press [MENU/SET]
Picture selected
You can select [All Delete Except Favorite] in [Delete All] if there are pictures that have been set
as [Favorite] (→223).
3
(When [Delete Multi] is selected)
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
(repeat)
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
OK
4
(When [Delete Multi] is selected)
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
May take time depending on number of pictures deleted.
169
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Rec] 169 [Custom] 189 [Playback] 207
[Motion Picture] 187 [Setup] 198
[Rec]
• The [Photo Style], [Filter Settings], [Sensitivity], [AF Mode], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering
Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic], [i.Resolution], [Diffraction Compensation],
[i.Zoom], [Digital Zoom], and [Stabilizer] menu items are common for both [Rec] and
[Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same
name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
[Photo Style] (→170)
[Filter Settings] (→172)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)
[Picture Size] (→174)
[Quality] (→174)
[Sensitivity] (→104)
[AF Mode] (→89)
[AFS/AFF/AFC] (→88)
[Metering Mode] (→175)
[Burst Rate] (→127)
[4K PHOTO] (→110)
[Bracket] (→130)
[Self Timer] (→129)
[Highlight Shadow] (→176)
[i.Dynamic] (→177)
[i.Resolution] (→177)
[iHandheld Night Shot] (→53)
[iHDR] (→54)
[HDR] (→178)
[Multi Exp.] (→179)
[Time Lapse Shot] (→133)
[Stop Motion Animation] (→135)
[Panorama Settings] (→70)
[Shutter Type] (→180)
[Flash] (→146)
[Red-Eye Removal] (→181)
[ISO Limit Set] (→181)
[ISO Increments] (→181)
[Extended ISO] (→182)
[Long Shtr NR] (→182)
[Diffraction Compensation] (→182)
[i.Zoom] (→141)
[Digital Zoom] (→142)
[Color Space] (→183)
[Stabilizer] (→138)
[Face Recog.] (→183)
[Profile Setup] (→186)
170
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Photo Style]
Recording mode:
You can adjust the colors and picture quality according to the concept of the picture that
you want to create.
[Rec] → [Photo Style]
[Standard] Standard setting.
[Vivid]
*
Setting with slightly high contrast and saturation.
[Natural]
*
Setting with slightly low contrast.
[Monochrome]
Setting that creates a picture using monochrome shades of gray only,
such as black and white.
[Scenery]
*
Setting that creates a picture using vivid colors for the blue sky and
green.
[Portrait]
*
Setting that produces the look of a healthy complexion.
[Custom]
*
Setting for using colors and picture quality that were registered in
advance.
*
This setting is not available in Intelligent Auto Plus Mode.
In Intelligent Auto Plus Mode, the setting will be reset to [Standard] when the camera is switched
to another Recording mode or this unit is turned on and off.
Only picture quality adjustment can be set in the Scene Guide Mode.
171
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
Adjusting the picture quality
• Picture quality cannot be adjusted in the Intelligent Auto
Plus Mode.
Standard
Press to select the type of Photo Style
Press to select an item and press to adjust
[Contrast]
[+] Increases the contrast in a picture.
[–] Decreases the contrast in a picture.
[Sharpness]
[+] Enhances the outlines in a picture.
[–] Softens the outlines in a picture.
[Noise Reduction]
[+]
Increases the noise reduction effect to reduce noise. This
setting may slightly lower the resolution.
[–]
Lowers the noise reduction effect to achieve a picture
quality with clearer resolution.
[Saturation]
*
1
[+] Gaudy coloring
[–] Subdued coloring
[Color Tone]
*
1
[+] Bluish coloring
[–] Yellowish coloring
[Filter Effect]
*
2
[Yellow]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Low)
Records a blue sky clearly.
[Orange]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: Medium)
Records a blue sky with vibrant colors.
[Red]
Enhances the contrast of a subject. (Effect: High)
Records a blue sky with even more vibrant colors.
[Green]
Applies subdued coloring for the skin and lips of a person.
Emphasizes green leaves and makes them brighter.
[Off]
*
1
[Color Tone] is displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected. Otherwise, [Saturation] is
displayed.
*
2
Displayed only when [Monochrome] is selected.
When the picture quality is adjusted, [+] will be displayed in the [Photo Style] icon.
Press [MENU/SET]
Registering the setting for the adjusted picture quality to [Custom]
Perform the picture quality adjustment in Step of “Adjusting the picture quality” and
press the [DISP.] button
172
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Filter Settings]
Recording mode:
You can apply picture effects (filters) that are available for Creative Control Mode to
images in other modes, such as Aperture-Priority AE Mode or Panorama Shot Mode.
(→76)
[Rec] → [Filter Settings] → [Filter Effect]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF] / [SET]
With touch screen operations
Touch [ ]
EXPSEXPS
Touch the item you want to set
[ ]: Picture effects ON or OFF
[ ]: Picture effects (Filter)
[ ]: Adjusting the picture effect
Cannot be used during [High Speed Video] recording.
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Toy Effect]
*
1
, [Toy Pop]
*
1
, [Miniature Effect]
*
1,
*
2
,
[Soft Focus], [Star Filter] and [Sunshine] are not available in the following cases.
Creative Video Mode
During motion picture recording
*
1
When [4K Live Cropping] is set
*
2
When the motion picture size is [4K] in [Rec Quality].
The following functions are not available in Panorama Shot Mode.
[Toy Effect], [Toy Pop], [Miniature Effect], [Sunshine]
When recording panorama pictures, the following effects are not applied to the recording screen.
[Rough Monochrome], [Silky Monochrome], [Soft Focus], [Star Filter]
When recording a panorama picture in a scene with low brightness, you may not be able to
achieve the desired results if [High Key] is used in the Panorama Shot Mode.
When recording in Self Shot Mode, only the following picture effects (filters) can be set.
[Expressive], [Retro], [High Key], [Toy Effect], [Soft Focus]
The available ISO sensitivity settings will be limited up to [3200]. The ISO sensitivity for
[High Dynamic] will be fixed to [AUTO].
173
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
Taking two still pictures with and without picture effects
([Simultaneous record w/o filter])
You can take two still pictures at the same time by pressing the shutter button once; one
with effects and one without effects.
[Rec] → [Filter Settings] → [Simultaneous record w/o filter]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
• The camera will take a still picture with the effects applied and then a still picture
without the effects.
• After taking the picture, [Auto Review] will display only the still picture with the effects
applied.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Panorama Shot Mode
When using [Burst]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
Taking still pictures while a motion picture is being recorded.
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When recording using [Bracket]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
[Aspect Ratio]
Recording mode:
This allows you to select the aspect ratio of the pictures to suit printing or the playback
method.
[Rec] → [Aspect Ratio]
[4:3] Aspect ratio of a 4:3 TV
[3:2] Aspect ratio of standard film cameras
[16:9] Aspect ratio of high-definition TV, etc.
[1:1] Aspect ratio of a square image
174
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Picture Size]
Recording mode:
The higher the numbers of pixels, the finer the detail of the pictures will appear even
when they are printed onto large sheets.
[Rec] → [Picture Size]
[Aspect Ratio] 4:3 3:2 16:9 1:1
[Picture Size]
[L] 17.5M
4864×3648
[L] 20M
5472×3648
[L] 17M
5472×3080
[L] 13.5M
3648×3648
[ M] 9M
3456×2592
[ M] 10M
3888×2592
[ M] 8M
3840×2160
[ M] 6.5M
2592×2592
[ S] 4.5M
2432×1824
[ S] 5M
2736×1824
[ S] 2M
1920×1080
[ S] 3.5M
1824×1824
The picture size will be fixed to [4K] ([4:3]: 3328×2496; [3:2]: 3504×2336; [16:9]: 3840×2160; [1:1]:
2880×2880) when recording 4K photos or recording in Post Focus.
[Quality]
Recording mode:
Set the compression rate used for storing pictures.
[Rec] → [Quality]
Settings File format Description
[
]
JPEG
Gives priority to picture quality and saves pictures in JPEG file
format.
[
]
Saves pictures in JPEG file format using standard picture quality.
This setting is useful when you want to increase the number of
recordable pictures without changing the number of pixels.
[
]
RAW + JPEG
Saves pictures in JPEG file format ([
] or [ ]) in addition to the
RAW file format.
*
1
[ ]
[
] RAW
Saves pictures in RAW file format.
*
2
*
1
If you delete a RAW file from the camera, the corresponding JPEG file is also deleted.
*
2
A RAW still picture is always recorded at [3:2] (5472×3648).
175
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
About RAW file
In RAW file format the data is saved without any picture processing by the camera. To play back and
edit RAW file pictures, you must use this unit or dedicated software.
You can develop the RAW file pictures using [RAW Processing] in the [Playback] menu. (→212)
To develop and edit RAW file pictures on a PC, use the software (Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s
“SILKYPIX Developer Studio”). To get this software, download it from the supplier’s website and
install it on your PC. (→275)
When you play back a picture recorded with [ ], the gray area is displayed according to the
aspect ratio of the picture during recording.
The setting is fixed to [ ] when recording 4K photos or recording in [Post Focus].
You cannot set to [ ], [ ] or [ ] in the following cases:
Panorama Shot Mode
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
[Metering Mode]
Recording mode:
You can change the metering method used for measuring brightness.
[Rec] → [Metering Mode]
[Metering Mode] Brightness measurement position Conditions
(Multiple)
Whole screen
Normal usage
(produces balanced pictures)
(Center weighted)
Center and surrounding area Subject in center
(Spot)
Center of [+] (spot metering target)
Great difference between
brightness of subject and
background
(e.g. person in spotlight on stage,
backlighting)
If you set the spot metering target on the edge of the screen, the metering may be affected by the
brightness around the location.
176
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Highlight Shadow]
Recording mode:
You can adjust the highlights and shadows in a picture while confirming the brightness of
these areas on the screen.
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Rec] → [Highlight Shadow]
([Standard]) No adjustments.
([Higher contrast])
Makes the highlighted areas brighter and shadowed areas
darker.
([Lower contrast])
Makes the highlighted areas darker and shadowed areas
brighter.
([Brighten shadows]) Makes the shadowed areas brighter.
/ / (Custom)
You can set a custom registration shape.
2
Rotate the control ring to adjust the brightness of the
highlighted areas and rotate the rear dial to adjust the
brightness of the shadowed areas
Highlighted area
Shadowed area
Preview display
To register your preferred settings, press
to select the
registration target icon (Custom 1, Custom 2, and Custom 3).
Adjustments can also be made by dragging the graph.
3
Press [MENU/SET]
You can press the [DISP.] button on the brightness adjustment screen to switch the screen display.
The settings adjusted in [ ], [ ], [ ], or [ ] will be restored to the default settings when the
camera is turned off.
177
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[i.Dynamic]
Recording mode:
Automatically adjusts contrast and exposure to give more lifelike colors when there is
significant contrast between background and subject.
[Rec] → [i.Dynamic]
Settings: [AUTO] / [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW] / [OFF]
This function is not available in the following cases:
When [HDR] is set to [ON]
When [Sensitivity] is set to [H.16000], [H.20000] or [H.25600]
[i.Resolution]
Recording mode:
You can use the camera’s Intelligent Resolution technology to record still pictures with
sharper outlines and clearer resolution.
[Rec] → [i.Resolution]
Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [LOW] / [EXTENDED] / [OFF]
When [EXTENDED] is set, you can take more natural pictures with the impression of high-
resolution.
The [EXTENDED] setting will automatically change to the [LOW] setting while recording motion
pictures, recording 4K photos, or recording in [Post Focus].
178
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[HDR]
Recording mode:
The camera can combine 3 still pictures taken at different exposures into a single
properly exposed picture with rich gradation. The individual pictures used to create the
HDR picture are not saved. You can minimize the loss of gradations in bright areas and
dark areas when, for example, the contrast between the background and the subject is
large.
A combined HDR picture is saved in JPEG format.
[Rec] → [HDR]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF] / [SET]
Changing the settings
[Dynamic Range]
[AUTO]: Takes pictures after automatically setting the adjustment range of
the exposure based on the contrast of a subject.
[±1EV] / [±2EV] / [±3EV]: Takes pictures using the adjustment range of the
exposure being set.
[Auto Align]
[ON]: Automatically adjusts the displacement of pictures caused by jitter,
etc. We recommend using this setting to take pictures with a handheld
camera.
[OFF]: Does not adjust the displacement of pictures. We recommend using
this setting when you use a tripod.
After the shutter button has been pressed, do not move the camera during the burst operation.
Since a burst of still pictures are combined after they have been recorded, it will be a few
moments before you will be able to record another picture.
A subject that was in motion when it was recorded may be recorded as an afterimage.
When [Auto Align] is set to [ON], the angle of view narrows slightly.
When you take pictures using a flash, the flash mode is fixed to [ ] (Forced Flash Off).
This function will not work for still pictures while motion pictures are being recorded.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
When using [Burst]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When recording using [Bracket]
When [Quality] is set to [
], [ ] or [ ]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
179
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Multi Exp.]
Recording mode:
You can create an effect similar to the operation of up to four times of exposure on a
single picture.
[Rec] → [Multi Exp.]
1
Press to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Decide on your composition and take the first picture
After recording the first picture, press the shutter button halfway
to proceed to the next recording.
Press
to select the item and press [MENU/SET]. You can
perform the following operations.
[Next]: Proceed to the next recording.
[Retake]: Delete the result of the last shot and take another
picture.
[Exit]: Exit Multi Exposure and save the picture that was taken.
Next
Retake
Exit
3
Record the second, third, and fourth pictures
When you press [Fn1] button while taking pictures, the pictures
that you took are saved and Multi Exposure is closed.
Retake
Exit
4
Press to select [Exit] and press [MENU/SET]
You can also end the operation by pressing the shutter button
halfway.
Changing the settings
[Auto Gain]
If you select [OFF], all exposure results are superimposed as they are.
Compensate the exposure as necessary, depending on the subject.
[Overlay]
If you select [ON], you can apply Multi Exposure to previously recorded
pictures. After [Start] is selected, pictures on the card will be displayed. Select
a RAW image, and press [MENU/SET] to proceed to recording.
Information for the picture taken last will be used as recording information of pictures taken using
Multi Exposure.
While [Multi Exp.] recording is being performed, you cannot set items displayed in gray on the
menu screen.
You can perform [Overlay] on RAW file pictures recorded using this camera only.
This function is not available in the following cases:
In Self Shot Mode
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When using [Stop Motion Animation]
180
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Shutter Type]
Recording mode:
You can take pictures using two types of shutter modes: the mechanical shutter and
electronic shutter.
Mechanical shutter Electronic shutter
Flash
Shutter Speed
(seconds)
T (Time)
*
1
, 60 - 1/4000
1 - 1/16000
Shutter sound
Mechanical shutter sound
+
Electronic shutter sound
*
2
Electronic shutter sound
*
2
*
1
This setting is available only in Manual Exposure Mode. (→64)
*
2
You can use [Shutter Vol.] and [Shutter Tone] to adjust the volume of the electronic shutter sound.
(→200)
[Rec] → [Shutter Type]
[AUTO]
The shutter mode automatically switches based on the recording conditions and
shutter speed.
The mechanical shutter mode has higher priority over the electronic shutter
mode because the mechanical shutter has less function-related restrictions
when recording with a flash, etc.
[MSHTR] Uses only the mechanical shutter mode to take a picture.
[ESHTR] Uses only the electronic shutter mode to take a picture.
In the following cases, recording is performed with an electronic shutter.
[
] is displayed on the screen
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
If you take a picture of a moving subject using the electronic shutter, the subject in the
picture may be skewed in some cases.
When you take a picture under a fluorescent or LED lighting fixture using the electronic
shutter, the recorded picture may have horizontal stripes. If you use a slower shutter
speed, the horizontal stripes may be reduced. (→63)
181
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Red-Eye Removal]
Recording mode:
Automatically detects red-eye and corrects still picture data when recording with flash
red-eye reduction ([ ], [ ]).
[Rec] → [Red-Eye Removal]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
When this function is set to [ON], the flash icon changes to [ ]/[ ].
Depending on the circumstance, it may not be possible to correct red-eye.
[ISO Limit Set]
Recording mode:
You can set the upper limit of ISO sensitivity when ISO sensitivity is set to [AUTO] or
[ ].
[Rec] → [ISO Limit Set]
Settings: [200] / [400] / [800] / [1600] / [3200] / [6400] / [12800] / [OFF]
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape], [Handheld Night Shot]
(Scene Guide Mode)
During motion picture recording
[ISO Increments]
Recording mode:
You can change the setting to increase ISO sensitivity by 1 EV or 1/3 EV.
[Rec] → [ISO Increments]
Settings: [1/3EV] / [1 EV]
182
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Extended ISO]
Recording mode:
You can extend the numeric values that can be set for ISO Sensitivity.
[Rec] → [Extended ISO]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
The setting cannot be made during 4K photo recording or recording in [Post Focus].
[Long Shtr NR]
Recording mode:
The camera can automatically eliminate the noise made when taking pictures with a
slower shutter speed (e.g. to record night scenes) in order to take sharp pictures.
[Rec] → [Long Shtr NR]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
While the camera eliminates the noise, [Long shutter noise reduction ongoing] is displayed for the
same period as the shutter speed for the signal processing time.
This function is not available in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When recording burst pictures with [Burst Rate] set to [SH]
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When using the electronic shutter
[Diffraction Compensation]
Recording mode:
The camera raises the resolution by correcting the blurriness caused by diffraction when
the aperture is closed.
[Rec] → [Diffraction Compensation]
Settings: [AUTO] / [OFF]
Noise in the periphery of the picture may stand out with higher ISO sensitivity.
183
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Color Space]
Recording mode:
You can set the method for reproducing the colors to correctly display the recorded
pictures on the screens of a PC or printer, etc.
[Rec] → [Color Space]
[sRGB] Sets the sRGB color space. This setting is widely used for devices such as PCs.
[AdobeRGB]
Sets the AdobeRGB color space.
AdobeRGB color space has a wider color reproduction range than sRGB color
space. Therefore, AdobeRGB color space is mainly used for business applications
such as commercial printing.
Select [sRGB] if you do not have expert knowledge about AdobeRGB color space.
The setting is fixed to [sRGB] while recording motion pictures, recording 4K photos, or recording
in [Post Focus].
[Face Recog.]
Recording mode:
The Face Recognition function recognizes a face similar to a registered face and
automatically adjusts focus and exposure for the face with higher priority. Even if a person
you want to focus on is standing at the back or corner in a group photo, the camera will
automatically recognize the person and record this person’s face clearly.
[Rec] → [Face Recog.]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF] / [MEMORY]
How the Face Recognition function works
During recording
• The camera recognizes a registered face and adjusts focus
and exposure.
• When registered faces that have set names are recognized,
the names are displayed (max. 3 people).
During playback
• The name and age are displayed.
• Only pictures of the selected registered people are played
back ([Category Play]).
184
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Face Recog.] functions only when Auto Focus mode is set to [ ].
Only the first picture of the burst recording will contain Face Recognition information.
The name of the person recognized in the first picture is displayed in the case of group pictures.
Even if Face Recognition information is registered, pictures recorded when the name is [OFF] are
not categorized for Face Recognition in [Category Play].
If you rename a registered person, pictures recorded before the renaming operation will no longer
be categorized by the Face Recognition function for [Category Play]. You can rename the person
in these pictures in [REPLACE] in [Face Rec Edit] (→225).
This function is not available in the following cases:
[Slimming Mode] (In Self Shot Mode)
[Miniature Effect] (Creative Control Mode)
During motion picture recording
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
Registering face pictures
Up to 6 people’s face pictures can be registered along with such information as name and
birthdate.
Use to select [MEMORY] and press [MENU/SET]
32
654
1
New
KEN
New
Use to select [New] and press [MENU/SET]
Align the face with the guide and record
Faces of subjects other than people (e.g. pets) cannot be
registered.
When
is pressed or [ ] is touched, an explanation is
displayed.
Use to select the item for editing and press [MENU/SET]
[Name] Set the name.
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
[Age] Set the birthdate.
[Add Images]
Use to select [Add] and press [MENU/SET]
When a registered face picture is selected with cursor button, a screen to
confirm deletion is displayed. Select [Yes] to delete the face picture.
Record the picture (step )
185
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
Recording tips when registering face pictures
• Make sure the subject’s eyes are open and mouth closed;
have the subject face the camera directly, and make sure
the outline of the face, the eyes and eyebrows are not
hidden by hair.
• Make sure there are no heavy shadows on the face. (During
registration, the flash is not used.)
Good example for registering
a face
If the camera seems to have difficulty recognizing faces when recording
• Register additional pictures of the same person’s face, indoors and outdoors or with
different expressions or angles.
• Register additional pictures at the place you are recording.
• If a registered person is no longer recognized, re-register that person.
• In some cases, the camera cannot recognize or incorrectly recognizes even registered
people depending on their expression or the environment.
Editing or deleting information about registered persons
Use to select [MEMORY] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select the picture of the person to be edited or deleted and press
[MENU/SET]
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[Info Edit]
Edit name or other registered information. (Step
of “Registering face pictures”)
[Priority] Set priority order for focus and exposure.
Use to select the registration order and press [MENU/SET]
[Delete] Delete information and face pictures of registered persons.
186
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Profile Setup]
Recording mode:
You can set a name or birthday of a baby or pet before taking a picture to record the
name or age in months/years in the picture.
Setting the name and age in months/years
[Rec] → [Profile Setup]
Settings: [ ] ([Baby1]) / [ ] ([Baby2]) / [ ] ([Pet]) / [OFF] / [SET]
Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [Baby1], [Baby2] or [Pet] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [Age] or [Name] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select [SET] and press [MENU/SET]
Enter the [Age].
Enter the [Name].
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
Use to select [Exit] and press [MENU/SET] to finish
Canceling the display of the name and age in months/years
Set [Profile Setup] to [OFF].
[Name] and [Age] print settings can be made on your computer using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
software (→274), which you download from a website. Text may also be stamped onto the still
picture using the camera’s [Text Stamp].
[Profile Setup] is not available for 4K photo recording or recording in [Post Focus].
You cannot record the name or age in months/years in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
Still pictures that are taken while recording motion pictures (→157)
187
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Motion Picture]
• The [Photo Style], [Filter Settings], [Sensitivity], [AF Mode], [AFS/AFF/AFC], [Metering
Mode], [Highlight Shadow], [i.Dynamic], [i.Resolution], [Diffraction Compensation],
[i.Zoom], [Digital Zoom], and [Stabilizer] menu items are common for both [Rec] and
[Motion Picture] menus. If a setting in one menu is changed, the setting with the same
name in other menu will also be changed automatically.
For details, refer to the corresponding item of the [Rec] menu.
[4K Live Cropping] (→154)
[Snap Movie] (→158)
[Rec Format] (→151)
[Rec Quality] (→151)
[Exposure Mode] (→82)
[High Speed Video] (→83)
[Continuous AF] (→153)
[Level Shot] (→187)
[Flkr Decrease] (→188)
[Silent Operation] (→84)
[Wind Noise Canceller] (→188)
[Level Shot]
Recording mode:
Level Shot function automatically detects the camera’s tilt while recording motion pictures,
and horizontally corrects the recording motion picture so it will not be tilted.
[Motion Picture] → [Level Shot]
Settings: [ON] / [OFF]
If the camera’s tilt is large, it may not be possible to horizontally correct the motion pictures.
When [Level Shot] is set to [ON]
The angle of view becomes slightly narrow when motion picture recording starts.
Still pictures taken while recording motion pictures will not be horizontally corrected.
This function is not available in the following cases:
When recording with [High Speed Video]
When [Stabilizer] is set to [OFF]
When [Rec Format] is set to [MP4], and [Rec Quality] is set to [4K/100M/30p] or [4K/100M/24p]
188
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Flkr Decrease]
Recording mode:
The shutter speed can be fixed to reduce the flicker or striping in the motion picture.
[Motion Picture] → [Flkr Decrease]
Settings: [1/50] / [1/60] / [1/100] / [1/120] / [OFF]
[Wind Noise Canceller]
Recording mode:
This will reduce the wind noise coming into the built-in microphone while maintaining
sound quality.
[Motion Picture] → [Wind Noise Canceller]
Settings: [HIGH] / [STANDARD] / [OFF]
• [HIGH] effectively reduces the wind noise by minimizing the low-pitched sound when a
strong wind is detected.
• [STANDARD] extracts and reduces only the wind noise without deteriorating the sound
quality.
You may not see the full effect depending on the recording conditions.
189
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Cust.Set Mem.] (→85)
[Silent Mode] (→189)
[AF/AE Lock] (→102)
[AF/AE Lock Hold] (→190)
[Shutter AF] (→190)
[Half Press Release] (→190)
[Quick AF] (→190)
[Pinpoint AF Time] (→190)
[Pinpoint AF Display] (→190)
[AF Assist Lamp] (→191)
[Focus/Release Priority] (→191)
[AF+MF] (→191)
[MF Assist] (→191)
[MF Assist Display] (→191)
[MF Guide] (→192)
[Peaking] (→192)
[Histogram] (→193)
[Guide Line] (→193)
[Center Marker] (→193)
[Highlight] (→194)
[Zebra Pattern] (→194)
[Monochrome Live View] (→195)
[Constant Preview] (→195)
[Expo.Meter] (→195)
[Dial Guide] (→195)
[Rec Area] (→196)
[Remaining Disp.] (→196)
[Auto Review] (→196)
[Fn Button Set] (→46)
[Zoom lever] (→196)
[Lens Position Resume] (→197)
[Lens Retraction] (→197)
[Q.MENU] (→197)
[Ring/Dial Set] (→36)
[Self Shot] (→197)
[Touch Settings] (→197)
[Touch Scroll] (→197)
[Menu Guide] (→197)
[Silent Mode]
Disabling the beeps and flash at the same time.
• This mode will mute beeps, set the flash to [ ] (Forced Flash Off), and disable AF
Assist Lamp. The settings for the following functions are fixed:
[Shutter Type]: [ESHTR]
Flash: [ ] (Forced Flash Off)
[AF Assist Lamp]: [OFF]
[Beep Volume]: [ ] (Off)
[Shutter Vol.]: [ ] (Off)
Even when this mode is set to [ON], the following lamps/indicators will light or flash.
Self-timer indicator
Wi-Fi connection lamp
The operation sounds of this camera such as the lens aperture sound are not muted.
[Custom]
[Custom]
190
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[AF/AE Lock Hold]
Focus and exposure stays locked even if you press and release the function button where
[AF/AE LOCK] is registered. Press the button again to cancel the lock.
[Shutter AF]
Set whether or not the focus is adjusted automatically when the shutter button is pressed
halfway.
[Half Press Release]
The shutter will immediately fire when the shutter button is pressed halfway.
[Quick AF]
The focus is automatically adjusted when camera blurring is small even when the shutter
button is not pressed. (Increases battery consumption).
This function is not available in the following cases:
Preview Mode
When the lighting is low
[Pinpoint AF Time]
Sets the time for which the screen is enlarged when the shutter button is pressed halfway
with Auto Focus Mode set to [ ].
[Pinpoint AF Display]
Sets whether to display the assist screen that appears when Auto Focus Mode is set to
[ ] in a window or full screen.
[Custom]
191
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Custom]
[AF Assist Lamp]
Illuminates the AF Assist Lamp when the shutter button is pressed halfway when it is too
dark to facilitate focusing.
The AF Assist Lamp has an effective distance of 1.5 m (4.9 feet).
The setting is fixed to [OFF] in the following cases:
[Distinct Scenery], [Bright Blue Sky], [Romantic Sunset Glow], [Vivid Sunset Glow], [Glistening
Water], [Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape], [Artistic Nightscape],
[Handheld Night Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON]
[Focus/Release Priority]
Disables recording when a subject is out of focus.
[AF+MF]
You can manually perform fine focusing during AF Lock (pressing the shutter button
halfway when [AFS/AFF/AFC] in [Rec] menu is set to [AFS] or setting AF Lock using the
[AF/AE LOCK]).
[MF Assist]
When you perform the Manual Focus operation, MF Assist (enlarged screen) appears.
Shortly after you stop operating Manual Focus, the display switches to normal.
MF Assist is not displayed in the following cases:
During motion picture recording
When recording with [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of the 4K Photo function
When using the Digital Zoom
[MF Assist Display]
Sets whether to display the MF Assist (enlarged screen) in a window or full screen.
192
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[MF Guide]
When you focus manually, the MF guide is displayed on the
screen. You can check whether the point of focus is to the
near side or the far side.
Indicator for (infinity)
[Peaking]
When you perform Manual Focus operation, this function automatically adds color to the
portions of the image that are in Focus (portions on the screen with clear outlines).
When [Detect Level] in [SET] is set to [HIGH], portions to be highlighted are reduced, allowing you
to achieve a more precise focus.
Changing the [Detect Level] setting also changes the [Display Color] setting as follows.
[Detect Level] [HIGH] [LOW]
[Display Color]
[
] (Light blue) [ ] (Blue)
[
] (Yellow) [ ] (Orange)
[
] (Yellow Green)
[ ] (Green)
[
] (Pink) [ ] (Red)
[
] (White) [ ] (Gray)
Each time [ ] in [ ] is touched, the setting is switched in order of [ON] ([Detect Level]: [LOW])
→ [ON] ([Detect Level]: [HIGH]) → [OFF].
This function is not available in the following case:
[Rough Monochrome] (Creative Control Mode)
[Custom]
193
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Custom]
[Histogram]
Enabling/disabling the histogram display.
When set to [ON], you can move the display position of the histogram by pressing .
• Direct touch operation is also possible from the recording screen.
Displays distribution of brightness in picture – e.g.
if the graph peaks at the right, this means there are
several bright areas in the picture. A peak in the center
represents correct brightness (correct exposure). This
can be used as a reference for exposure correction, etc.
(Example)
Dark ← OK → Bright
When the histogram is not the same as that of the recorded picture under the following
conditions, histogram will be displayed in orange:
During Exposure Compensation
When the flash fires.
When the correct exposure is not achieved, such as when the lighting is low.
[Guide Line]
Sets the pattern of the guidelines to be displayed while recording.
When you select [ ], you can move the position of the guideline by pressing .
You can also set the position directly by touching [ ] on the guideline of the recording screen.
The guideline is not displayed during panorama picture recording.
[Center Marker]
A cross [+] is displayed to indicate the center of the recording screen. This is useful for
zooming while keeping the subject at the center of the screen.
194
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Custom]
[Highlight]
You can set overexposed areas (areas that are too bright and where there are no shades
of gray) to flash on the screen when the [Auto Review] function is activated or during
playback. This does not affect recorded pictures.
To reduce overexposed areas, record a picture by setting negative
exposure compensation (→103) using the histogram display (→193) and
so on as a reference.
This feature is disabled during 4K photo playback, playback of pictures
recorded in Post Focus, Multi Playback, Calendar Playback, or Playback
Zoom.
[Zebra Pattern]
You can check the area in a picture, which could result in overexposure, by displaying
such an area using a zebra pattern.
[ZEBRA1]: [ZEBRA2]:
Select [SET] to set the brightness to be displayed for each zebra pattern.
• The range of brightness you can select from is [50%] to [105%]. The [OFF] setting is
available for [Zebra 2]. When [100%] or [105%] is selected, only the overexposed areas
are displayed with the zebra pattern. When a smaller numeric value is set, the range of
brightness to be displayed by each zebra pattern will increase.
To reduce overexposed areas, record a picture by setting negative exposure compensation
(→103) using the histogram display (→193) and so on as a reference.
The displayed zebra pattern is not recorded.
If you set [Zebra Pattern] to [Fn Button Set] (→46) in the [Custom] menu, every time you press
the assigned function button the setting will switch in the following order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra 2]
→ [Zebra OFF]. When [Zebra 2] is set to [OFF], you can switch the setting quickly in the following
order: [Zebra 1] → [Zebra OFF].
195
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Custom]
[Monochrome Live View]
You can display the recording screen in black and white. This function is useful when a
black and white screen will make it easier to adjust focus in Manual Focus mode.
This does not affect recorded pictures.
[Constant Preview]
You can check the effects of the chosen aperture and shutter speed on the recording
screen in Manual Exposure Mode.
This function is disabled when the flash is used.
[Expo.Meter]
Enabling/disabling the exposure meter display.
Exposure meter
When you set this function to [ON], an exposure meter is displayed
during Program Shift, aperture setting, and shutter speed
operation.
Proper exposure is not possible in the range indicated in red.
If the exposure meter is not displayed, press the [DISP.] button to
switch the display of the monitor.
The exposure meter will turn off if no operation is performed for
approximately 4 seconds.
60
p
15 30 60 125 250
8.05.62.8 4.02.0
[Dial Guide]
Enabling/disabling the operation guide display.
Example
196
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Rec Area]
Switching the angle of view setting used for recording still pictures and motion pictures.
The recording area indicated is an approximation.
[Rec Area] is not available for 4K photo recording or recording in [Post Focus].
[Remaining Disp.]
Switching the display between the number of recordable pictures that you can take and
the available recording time.
[Auto Review]
Set the time to display the pictures you have taken after taking still pictures.
When [HOLD] is selected, pictures are displayed until you press the shutter button halfway.
During 4K Photo recording and [Post Focus] recording, the [Auto Review] settings items change to
[ON] and [OFF].
[Zoom lever]
Changing the zoom operation settings.
(Zoom)
The zoom operates in the normal way.
(Step Zoom)
Each time zoom is operated, the zoom stops at the position for one of the
preset focal lengths.
Focus range
Current zoom position
This setting does not work when
recording motion pictures or 4K photos
with [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]).
• The zoom or step zoom setting can be assigned to the control ring. (→36)
[Custom]
197
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Custom]
[Lens Position Resume]
Remember the zoom position and focus position when the camera is turned off.
[Lens Retraction]
Retract the lens barrel automatically after approx. 15 seconds as the camera is switched
to the playback screen from the recording screen.
[Q.MENU]
If you select [CUSTOM], you can customize the Quick Menu settings. (→45)
[Self Shot]
If this is set to [OFF], the camera will not switch to Self Shot Mode (→57) even if you
rotate the monitor.
[Touch Settings]
Enabling/disabling the touch operation.
[Touch Screen] All touch operations.
[Touch Tab]
Operations of tabs, such as [
] displayed on the right side of the screen.
[Touch AF]
Operation to optimize the focus [AF] or both the focus and brightness
[AF+AE] for a touched subject.
[Touch Scroll]
This allows you to set the speed of continuously forwarding or rewinding pictures using
touch operation.
[Menu Guide]
Displaying/not displaying the selection screen when the mode dial is switched to
[ ]/[ ].
198
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Online Manual] (→198)
[Clock Set] (→28)
[World Time] (→198)
[Travel Date] (→199)
[Wi-Fi] (→199)
[Beep] (→200)
[Live View Mode] (→200)
[Monitor Display] (→201)
[Monitor Luminance] (→201)
[Economy] (→202)
[USB Mode] (→202)
[TV Connection] (→203)
[m/ft] (→203)
[Menu Resume] (→204)
[Menu Background] (→204)
[Menu Information] (→204)
[Language] (→204)
[Version Disp.] (→204)
[Exposure Comp. Reset] (→204)
[Self Timer Auto Off] (→205)
[No.Reset] (→205)
[Reset] (→205)
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings] (→205)
[Level Gauge Adjust.] (→206)
[Demo Mode] (→206)
[Format] (→26)
[Online Manual]
Settings: [URL display] / [QR Code display]
[World Time]
Sets the times for the region where you live and your travel destination.
• You can set [Destination] after setting [Home].
Settings: [Destination] / [Home]
1
Use to select [Destination] or [Home] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select area and press [MENU/SET]
When [Destination] has been selected When [Home] has been selected
Current time at selected destination
City/area name
Difference with home time
[Setup]
[Setup]
199
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
To set daylight savings
Press
in step
2
. (Press again to release the setting)
When daylight savings [ ] is set, the current time is advanced by 1 hour. If the setting is
canceled, the time automatically returns to the current time.
When you come back from your travel destination
Select [Home] in step
1
and press [MENU/SET].
If you cannot find your destination in the area displayed on the screen, set based on difference
with home time.
[Travel Date]
[Travel Setup]
If you set your travel schedule and record pictures, the day of your trip on which the
picture was taken will be recorded.
To record [Location]
Once the [Travel Setup] is set, you can set the location.
• For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
To print [Location] or the number of days that have passed, either use [Text Stamp] (→219) or
print using the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software (→274).
The travel date is calculated from the set departure date and the date set in the camera’s clock.
When destination is set in [World Time], days elapsed are calculated based on local destination
time.
When [Travel Setup] is set to [OFF], the number of days elapsed is not recorded. It is not
displayed even if [Travel Setup] is set to [SET] after recording.
When the current date passes the return date, [Travel Setup] is automatically canceled.
[Travel Date] cannot be recorded for AVCHD motion pictures.
[Location] cannot be recorded while recording motion pictures, recording 4K photos, or recording
in [Post Focus].
[Wi-Fi]
Settings: [Wi-Fi Function] (→259) / [Wi-Fi Setup] (→266)
[Setup]
200
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Beep]
Sets the beep sounds or shutter sounds.
[Beep Volume]
[Shutter Vol.]
[Shutter Tone]
When [Silent Mode] is set to [ON], [Beep Volume] and [Shutter Vol.] are set to “Off”.
[Live View Mode]
Sets the display speed and picture quality of the screen (Live View screen) when
recording pictures.
[ECO 30fps] In the reduced power consumption setting, pictures are displayed at 30 fps.
[30fps] Pictures are displayed at 30 fps.
[60fps]
Display speed has higher priority over picture quality and pictures are displayed
at 60 fps.
For example, use when you want to record a fast-moving subject.
When [Live View Mode] is set to [ECO 30fps], Digital Zoom is not available.
Cannot set to [ECO 30fps] in the following cases:
Creative Video Mode
When recording 4K photos
When recording using [Post Focus]
The [Live View Mode] setting does not affect the recorded picture.
[Setup]
201
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Monitor Display]
Adjust brightness and color of the monitor.
[Brightness] Adjusts the brightness.
[Contrast] Adjusts the contrast.
[Saturation] Adjusts the vividness of colors.
[Red Tint] Adjusts red hues.
[Blue Tint] Adjusts blue hues.
Some subjects may look different from their actual appearance, but the recorded picture will not
be affected.
[Monitor Luminance]
Sets the monitor brightness according to the ambient light level.
The brightness is adjusted automatically depending on how bright it is around the camera.
The brightness is increased.
The brightness is standard.
The brightness is decreased.
Some subjects may look different from their actual appearance, but the recorded picture will not
be affected.
[ ] returns to ordinary brightness if there is no operation for 30 seconds when recording. (Press
any button or touch the screen to make the screen brighter again.)
Setting [ ] or [ ] reduces the operating time.
Cannot select [ ] during playback.
When the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional) are used, the initial setting is [ ].
[Setup]
202
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Economy]
[Sleep Mode]
The camera is automatically turned off if the camera has not been used for the time
selected on the setting.
To restore → Press the shutter button halfway, or turn the camera [ON/OFF] switch to
[OFF] and then turn it [ON] again
[Sleep Mode(Wi-Fi)]
The camera is automatically turned off if the camera has not been used for approx.
15 minutes with no Wi-Fi connection.
To restore → Press the shutter button halfway, or turn the camera [ON/OFF] switch to
[OFF] and then turn it [ON] again.
[Auto Monitor Off]
The monitor is automatically turned off if the camera has not been used for the time
selected on the setting.
To restore → Press any button or touch the monitor.
This function is not available in the following cases:
During motion picture recording/playback
When recording with [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]) of the 4K Photo function
When [Multi Exp.] is set
When connected to computer/printer
During Slide Shows
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
When [Auto Shooting] of [Stop Motion Animation] is set to [ON]
When using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), [Sleep Mode] or [Sleep
Mode(Wi-Fi)] is disabled.
When using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), [Auto Monitor Off] is fixed to [5
MIN.].
[USB Mode]
Select communication method for when connecting camera to a computer or printer with
USB connection cable (supplied).
[Select on connection]
Select communication method each time you connect to a
computer or PictBridge-compatible printer.
[PictBridge(PTP)] Select when connecting to a PictBridge-compatible printer.
[PC] Select when connecting to a computer.
[Setup]
203
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[TV Connection]
[HDMI Mode]
Set the format for the HDMI output when playing back on the HDMI compatible high-
definition TV connected with this unit using the HDMI micro cable.
[AUTO] Automatically sets the output resolution based on information from a connected TV.
[4K]
Outputs pictures with a resolution of 3840×2160 pixels using a progressive scan
method for the number of effective scanning lines (2,160 lines).
[1080p]
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning
lines (1,080 lines).
[1080i]
Outputs pictures using an interlace scan method for the number of effective scanning
lines (1,080 lines).
[720p]
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning
lines (720 lines).
[480p]
Outputs pictures using a progressive scan method for the number of effective scanning
lines (480 lines).
If no image appears on the TV with [AUTO], switch the setting to a constant setting other than
[AUTO] to set a format supported by your TV. (Please read the operating instructions for the TV.)
[VIERA Link]
If you select [ON], operations of the camera and the VIERA Link compatible equipment
connected to the camera with an HDMI micro cable are automatically linked, enabling you
to control the camera with the remote control of the VIERA Link compatible equipment.
(→272)
[m/ft]
Select how distance is displayed, in Ft or M.
[Setup]
204
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Menu Resume]
Save the last operated menu position.
[Menu Background]
Set the background color for the menu screen.
[Menu Information]
Explanations of the menu items and settings are displayed on the menu screen.
[Language]
Set the language displayed on the screen.
If you set a different language by mistake, select [ ] from the menu icons to set the desired
language.
[Version Disp.]
Check the firmware version of the camera.
When you press [MENU/SET] while the version is displayed, software information for this unit,
such as the license, is displayed.
[Exposure Comp. Reset]
If the recording mode is changed or the camera is turned off, the exposure compensation
(brightness) setting is reset.
[Setup]
205
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Self Timer Auto Off]
The self-timer is canceled if the unit is turned off.
[No.Reset]
Reset picture file numbers. (The folder number is updated and the file number starts from
0001.)
• To reset folder number to 100:
First, format the card, and reset the file numbers using [No.Reset]. Then, select [Yes]
on the folder number reset screen.
A folder number between 100 and 999 can be assigned.
Numbers cannot be reset once folder number reaches 999. In this case, save all necessary
pictures to your computer, and format the card (→26).
[Reset]
The following settings are reset to the default:
Recording settings (except for [Face Recog.] and [Profile Setup] settings) and
drive mode
Recording settings ([Face Recog.] and [Profile Setup] settings)
Setup/custom settings
When the setup/custom settings are reset, the following settings are also reset:
The [World Time] setting
The [Travel Date] setting (Departure date, Return date, [Location])
The settings of [Rotate Disp.] and [Picture Sort] in the [Playback] menu
Folder numbers and clock settings will not be reset.
[Reset Wi-Fi Settings]
Returns [Wi-Fi] settings to default settings.
(Excluding [LUMIX CLUB])
[Setup]
206
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Level Gauge Adjust.]
[Adjust.]
Hold the camera in a horizontal position, and press [MENU/SET]. The level gauge will be
adjusted.
[Level Gauge Value Reset]
Restores the default level gauge setting.
[Demo Mode]
You can try focusing, peaking, etc. in [Post Focus] (→121), with the image picture.
[Setup]
207
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Playback]
[Slide Show] (→208)
[Playback Mode] (→210)
[Location Logging] (→211)
[RAW Processing] (→212)
[4K PHOTO Bulk Saving] (→215)
[Light Composition] (→215)
[Clear Retouch] (→217)
[Title Edit] (→218)
[Text Stamp] (→219)
[Video Divide] (→220)
[Time Lapse Video] (→220)
[Stop Motion Video] (→221)
[Resize] (→221)
[Cropping] (→222)
[Rotate] (→222)
[Rotate Disp.] (→223)
[Favorite] (→223)
[Print Set] (→224)
[Protect] (→225)
[Face Rec Edit] (→225)
[Picture Sort] (→226)
In the following cases, new pictures are created after they have been edited. Before starting to
edit, make sure that there is enough free space in the memory card.
[RAW Processing] / [4K PHOTO Bulk Saving] / [Light Composition] / [Clear Retouch] /
[Text Stamp] / [Time Lapse Video] / [Stop Motion Video] / [Resize] / [Cropping]
It may not be possible to set or edit pictures taken with other cameras.
How to select an image(s) after selecting [Single] or [Multi]
When [Single] and [Multi] are not available, select a picture in the same way as when
[Single] is selected.
[Single]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
If [Set/Cancel] is displayed at the right bottom of the screen, the
setting is canceled when [MENU/SET] is pressed again.
SetSet
[Multi]
When a screen similar to the one on the right is
displayed:
OK
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
(repeat)
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
When a screen similar to the one on the right is
displayed:
2 3
4 5 6
1
Set/Cancel
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
(repeat)
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
208
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Slide Show]
Automatically play still pictures and motion pictures in order. You can also organize
slide shows by image category, such as only still pictures, only motion pictures, etc.
Recommended when viewing on TV screen.
[Playback] → [Slide Show]
1
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
If you select [Video Only], 4K burst files recorded with the 4K
Photo function and pictures recorded using [Post Focus] will also
be played back.
Only an in-focus representative image will be played back from
pictures recorded using [Post Focus].
For details about category, refer to (→210).
2
Use to select [Start] and press [MENU/SET]
Operations during Slide Show
Operation Touch operation Description
Play/Pause
Previous
Stop
Next
/
Volume down / Volume up
209
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
To change settings such as music or display time
Select [Effect] or [Setup] and press [MENU/SET].
[Effect] This allows you to select the screen effects when switching from one
picture to the next.
[AUTO] can be used only when [Category Selection] is selected.
The pictures are played back with the recommended effects for each
category.
[Setup] [Duration] [Duration] can be set only when [Effect] is set to [OFF].
[Repeat] [ON] / [OFF]
[Sound] [AUTO]: With still pictures, music will play back, and with motion
pictures, audio will play back.
[Music]: Music effect will play back.
[Audio]: Audio is played back from motion pictures.
[OFF]: Music and audio will not play back.
During slide shows of 4K burst files, pictures recorded in [Post Focus], or group pictures, effects
will stay turned off even if [Effect] is set.
When you play back the following pictures in a slide show, the [Duration] setting is disabled.
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Panorama pictures
Group pictures
210
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Playback Mode]
Recorded pictures can be played back in a variety of ways. ([Normal Play], [Picture Only],
[Video Only], [4K PHOTO], [Post Focus], [Category Play], [Favorite Play])
[Playback] → [Playback Mode]
1
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
If you select [Video Only], 4K burst files recorded with the 4K Photo function and pictures
recorded using [Post Focus] will also be played back.
2
(When selecting [Category Play])
Use to select the category and press [MENU/SET]
The available categories are as follows.
[Face Recog.]
[i-Portrait], [i-Night Portrait], [i-Baby] in Automatic Scene Detection
[Clear Portrait], [Silky Skin], [Backlit Softness], [Clear in Backlight], [Relaxing Tone],
[Sweet Child’s Face], [Clear Night Portrait] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Self Shot]
[i-Scenery], [i-Sunset] in Automatic Scene Detection
[Distinct Scenery], [Bright Blue Sky], [Romantic Sunset Glow], [Vivid Sunset Glow],
[Glistening Water] (Scene Guide Mode)
[i-Night Portrait], [i-Night Scenery], [i-Handheld Night Shot] in Automatic Scene
Detection
[Clear Nightscape], [Cool Night Sky], [Warm Glowing Nightscape], [Artistic Nightscape],
[Glittering Illuminations], [Handheld Night Shot], [Clear Night Portrait] (Scene Guide
Mode)
[Clear Sports Shot] (Scene Guide Mode)
[i-Food] in Automatic Scene Detection
[Appetizing Food], [Cute Dessert] (Scene Guide Mode)
[Travel Date]
A burst of pictures recorded by setting the burst speed to [SH], picture saved using [4K
PHOTO Bulk Saving]
[Time Lapse Shot], [Time Lapse Video]
[Stop Motion Animation], [Stop Motion Video]
211
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Location Logging]
After you send location information (latitude and longitude) obtained by your smartphone/
tablet to this unit, you can write this information on pictures using the unit.
Preparation
Send location information to this unit from your smartphone/tablet. (→238)
You must install “Panasonic Image App” on your smartphone/tablet. (→231)
[Playback] → [Location Logging]
1
Use to select [Add Location Data] and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select a period for writing location information, and press
[MENU/SET]
[ ] is displayed for pictures that have location information written to it.
Abort writing location information
Press [MENU/SET] while location information is being written
[ ] is displayed for the period of the abort operation.
If selected again while [
] is displayed, writing location information will resume where it left off.
Delete received location information
Use to select [Delete Location Data] and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select a period for deleting location information, and press [MENU/SET]
The location information cannot be written in the following cases:
Pictures that were recorded after you sent the location information (→238)
Pictures that already have location information
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] format
When you use your smartphone/tablet as a remote controller for this unit, you can write the
location information on pictures using the smartphone/tablet. (→239)
212
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[RAW Processing]
You can use the camera to develop still pictures that were recorded in RAW format. The
created still pictures are saved in JPEG format.
[Playback] → [RAW Processing]
1
Press to select RAW file and press [MENU/SET]
2
Press to select the item
The following items can be set. The settings used during
recording are applied at the time of setting.
[White Balance]
You can select White Balance to make adjustments. When you select an
item with [ ], you can develop the pictures using the same settings that
were applied for recording.
[Exposure Comp.]
You can perform Exposure Compensation in the range from –1 EV to
+1 EV.
[Photo Style]
You can select the [Photo Style] effects ([Standard], [Vivid], [Natural],
[Monochrome], [Scenery], or [Portrait]).
[i.Dynamic]
You can select the [i.Dynamic] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW], or
[OFF]).
[Contrast] You can adjust the contrast.
[Highlight] You can adjust the brightness of a highlighted area.
[Shadow] You can adjust the brightness of a shadowed area.
[Saturation] /
[Color Tone]
You can adjust the saturation. (You can adjust the coloring when
[Monochrome] is selected for [Photo Style].)
[Filter Effect]
You can select a Filter effect. (Only when [Monochrome] is selected for
[Photo Style].)
[Noise Reduction] You can set noise reduction.
[i.Resolution]
You can select the [i.Resolution] settings ([HIGH], [STANDARD], [LOW],
[EXTENDED], or [OFF]).
[Sharpness] You can adjust the impression of resolution.
[Setup]
You can perform the following settings.
[Reinstate Adjustments]: You can restore the settings to the ones used
during recording.
[Color Space]: You can select [Color Space] from either [sRGB] or
[AdobeRGB].
[Picture Size]: You can select the picture size ([L], [M], or [S]) of a JPEG
file when saving pictures.
3
Press [MENU/SET] to set
The setting methods vary depending on the item. For details, refer to “Setting each item”
(→213).
213
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
4
Press [MENU/SET]
The screen in step
2
reappears. To set another item, repeat steps
2
to
4
.
5
Press to select [Begin Processing] and press [MENU/SET]
Setting each item
When you select an item, the setting screen appears.
Operation
Touch
operation
Description
Drag Used to make adjustments
[WB K Set]
Used to display the color
temperature setting screen (→106)
(Only when [White Balance] is set
to [
])
[Adjust.]
Used to display the White Balance
fine adjustment screen (→108)
(Only when [White Balance] is set)
[DISP.] [DISP.]
Used to display the comparison
screen
[MENU/SET] [Set]
Used to finalize an adjustment you
just made and to return to the item
selection screen
SetSet
SetSetAdjust.Adjust.
• If you have selected [Noise Reduction], [i.Resolution], or [Sharpness], the comparison
screen is not displayed.
• Pictures can be enlarged by operating the zoom lever.
• You can also zoom in by quickly touching the touch screen twice. (If the display was
enlarged, it returns to the same magnification ratio.)
214
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
The following operating methods are available to make adjustments on the comparison
screen.
Current setting
Operation
Touch
operation
Description
Drag Used to make adjustments
[DISP.] [DISP.] Used to return to the setting screen
[MENU/SET] [Set]
Used to finalize an adjustment you
just made and to return to the item
selection screen
SetSet
• If you touch the picture at the center, it will be enlarged. If you touch [ ], the picture
will be reduced to the original size.
When [Setup] is selected
When you select an item, the screen for selecting [Reinstate Adjustments], [Color Space],
or [Picture Size] is displayed.
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
When [Reinstate Adjustments] is selected, confirmation screen is displayed. When you select
[Yes], the item selection screen reappears.
Use to select the setting and press [MENU/SET]
The result of a RAW file developed by this camera and a RAW file developed by the software
“SILKYPIX Developer Studio SE” (→275) will not be exactly the same.
Regardless of the aspect ratio of the picture during recording, a RAW image recorded on this
camera is always recorded with the aspect ratio set to [3:2] (5472×3648), but if you perform [RAW
Processing] from the [Playback] menu, the picture will be processed with the aspect ratio fixed as
that at the time of recording.
The [White Balance] setting of still pictures recorded using [Multi Exp.] is fixed to the setting used
during recording.
When an HDMI micro cable is connected, [RAW Processing] is disabled.
You can perform RAW processing on pictures recorded using this unit only.
215
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[4K PHOTO Bulk Saving]
You can bulk save 5 seconds’ worth of 4K recording from a 4K burst file.
[Playback] → [4K PHOTO Bulk Saving]
1
Use to select the 4K burst files and press [MENU/SET]
If the burst time is 5 seconds or less, all the frames can be saved as a picture.
2
Select the first frame to be bulk saved as a picture
The selection method is the same as the operation to choose the frame you want to save as a
picture from a 4K burst file. For details (→117).
The picture will be saved in JPEG format as a single burst picture group (→166).
[Light Composition]
Select multiple frames from 4K burst files that you wish to combine. Parts of the image
that are brighter than the preceding frame will be superimposed on the preceding frame
to combine the frames into one picture.
[Playback] → [Light Composition]
1
Use to select the 4K burst files and press [MENU/SET]
2
Choose the combining method and press [MENU/SET]
When [Composite Merging] is selected
Select the frames you wish to combine, and then camera superimposes brighter parts of the
image.
Select the frames
For button and touch operation, refer to (→119).
Images displayed cannot be enlarged or shrunk or shown as
in slide view
[
] in touch operation becomes [ ].
216
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
Press [MENU/SET]
The selected frames are remembered, and the display goes to the preview screen.
Use
to select items and press [MENU/SET] to perform the following operations.
[Next]: Lets you select more frames for combining. Goes back to step
.
[Reselect]: Discards the frame selected immediately before and lets you select a different
image.
[Save]: Ends frame selection.
Repeat steps - to select more frames to combine
You can select up to 40 frames.
Press to select [Save], and then press [MENU/SET]
When [Range Merging] is selected
Select the first and last frames, and the brighter parts of frames within that range will be
superimposed.
Select the frame of the first picture and then press [MENU/SET]
The selection method is the same as in step when selecting [Composite Merging].
Select the frame of the last picture and then press [MENU/SET]
3
Select [Yes] at the confirmation screen and press [MENU/SET]
The combined picture is displayed.
Pictures are saved in JPEG format. Recording information (Exif information) of the first frame
such as shutter speed, aperture, and ISO sensitivity are also registered.
217
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Clear Retouch]
• The erasure operation can only be
performed by touching. [Clear Retouch]
automatically enables the touch
operation.
[Playback] → [Clear Retouch]
1
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
SetSet
UndoUndo
SCALINGSCALING
REMOVEREMOVE
2
Drag your finger over the part you want to erase
The parts to be erased are colored.
Touching [Undo] will return the colored part back to its previous
state.
Erasing details (enlarging the display)
SetSet
Undo
Undo
SCALINGSCALING
REMOVE
REMOVE
Touch [SCALING]
On the touch screen, pinch out your two fingers to zoom in, and
pinch in your two fingers to zoom out (→39).
You can also zoom in/out with the zoom lever.
Dragging the screen allows you to move the enlarged part.
Touch [REMOVE]
This will bring you back to the operation of dragging your finger
over the part you want to erase. The part you want to erase can
be dragged even while the picture is enlarged.
3
Touch [Set]
4
Touch [Save] or press [MENU/SET]
Pictures may appear unnatural because the background of deleted parts is artificially created.
For group pictures, perform [Clear Retouch] on each picture. (They cannot be edited at once.)
When [Clear Retouch] is performed on group pictures, they are saved as new pictures separate
from the original ones.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Panorama pictures
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
218
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Title Edit]
You can enter characters (titles etc.) on a recorded picture. After text has been registered,
it can be stamped in prints using [Text Stamp] (→219).
[Playback] → [Title Edit]
1
Select a still picture (→207)
[ ] is displayed for pictures with texts already stamped.
2
Enter characters
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
To delete texts, delete all the characters in the character input screen.
You can print out texts using the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software (→274).
You can set up to 100 pictures at one time with [Multi].
This function is not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
], [ ] or [ ]
219
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Text Stamp]
You can stamp the recording date and time, names, travel destination, travel dates, etc.
on the recorded still pictures.
[Playback] → [Text Stamp]
1
Select a still picture (→207)
[ ] appears on screen if the picture is stamped with text.
2
Use to select [Set] and press [MENU/SET]
[Shooting Date] [W/O TIME]: Stamp recording date
[WITH TIME]: Stamp recording date and time
[Name]
: Stamp name registered in Face Recognition
: Stamp name registered in [Profile Setup]
[Location] Stamp location registered in [Setup] menu’s [Travel Date]
[Travel Date] Stamp number of days that have elapsed since the travel date set in [Setup]
menu’s [Travel Date]
[Title] Stamp text registered in [Title Edit]
3
Press [Q.MENU/ ] button
4
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
Do not request date printing in store or make date printing on printer for still pictures with
date stamps. (Date printing may be overlapped.)
You can set up to 100 pictures at one time with [Multi].
The picture quality may be coarser.
If you stamp text on the pictures in a group, those pictures are saved as new pictures.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
Still pictures taken without setting clock
220
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Video Divide]
A single motion picture can be split into 2 parts. This is convenient when you want to keep
just the necessary scenes, or if you wish to delete unnecessary scenes to increase free
space on your card, such as when traveling.
[Playback] → [Video Divide]
1
Use to select a motion picture to split and press [MENU/SET]
2
Press at where you want to split a motion picture to
pause it
If you press while paused, you can make finer adjustments
to the splitting positions in a motion picture.
3
Press
The original motion picture that was split does not remain.
(There will only be the 2 motion pictures that were created after
the split.)
During dividing, do not turn off the camera or remove the card or battery. If you do so, the motion
picture may be deleted.
Motion pictures cannot be divided at a location close to the start or end of the motion picture.
This function is not available in the following case:
Motion pictures with a short recording time
[Time Lapse Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using
[Time Lapse Shot]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording format.
[Playback] → [Time Lapse Video]
1
Use to select the [Time Lapse Shot] picture group and press
[MENU/SET]
2
Create a motion picture after selecting a production method
For details, refer to step
4
and the subsequent steps (→134).
For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→134).
221
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Stop Motion Video]
You can create a motion picture from the pictures in a group that was recorded using
[Stop Motion Animation]. The motion picture you created is saved in the MP4 recording
format.
[Playback] → [Stop Motion Video]
1
Use to select a stop motion animation group and press [MENU/SET]
2
Create a motion picture after selecting a production method
For details, refer to step
7
and the subsequent steps (→136).
For details on the motion picture you created, refer to (→137).
[Resize]
Picture size can be reduced to facilitate e-mail attachment and use in web pages, etc.
[Playback] → [Resize]
1
Select a still picture and size
[Single]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select size and press [MENU/SET]
SetSet
[Multi] (up to 100 pictures)
Use to select size and press [MENU/SET]
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
(repeat)
To cancel → Press [MENU/SET] again.
Use to select [OK] and press [MENU/SET]
OK
Picture quality is reduced after resizing.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Group pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
222
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Cropping]
Enlarge your still pictures and crop unwanted areas.
[Playback] → [Cropping]
1
Use to select a still picture and press [MENU/SET]
2
Select area to crop and press [MENU/SET]
You can also touch [ ] / [ ] to enlarge/reduce.
You can also move by dragging on the screen.
Enlarge Change
position
Perform cropping for each picture in the group. (You cannot edit pictures in group units.)
If you crop a picture in the group, it is saved as a new picture.
Original Face Recognition information will not be copied when still pictures are cropped.
Picture quality is reduced after cropping.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
Panorama pictures
Still pictures that other texts had already been stamped
[Rotate]
You can manually rotate the picture in 90-degree units.
• You cannot select [Rotate] when [Rotate Disp.] is set to [OFF].
[Playback] → [Rotate]
1
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select the rotation direction and press
[MENU/SET]
[ ]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees clockwise.
[
]: Rotate a picture 90 degrees counterclockwise.
223
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Rotate Disp.]
This mode allows you to display pictures vertically if they were recorded holding the
camera vertically.
[Playback] → [Rotate Disp.] → [ON]
When you play back pictures on a PC, they cannot be displayed in the rotated direction unless the
OS or software is compatible with Exif. Exif is a file format for still pictures which allows recording
information, etc. to be added. It was established by “JEITA (Japan Electronics and Information
Technology Industries Association)”.
[Favorite]
By labeling your favorite pictures with a star [ ], you can play back your favorite pictures
only, or you can delete all pictures except your favorites.
[Playback] → [Favorite]
1
Select picture (→207)
To clear all
Select [Favorite] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
Up to 999 pictures can be set.
Only when [Playback Mode] is set to [Normal Play], you can select [Cancel].
This function is not available in the following case:
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
224
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Print Set]
Picture/picture no./date printing settings can be made for when printing with DPOF
print-compatible shops or printers. (Contact the local photo printing store or read
operating instructions of the printer to check if DPOF is supported.)
For more information visit:
http://panasonic.jp/dc/dpof_110/white_e.htm
[Playback] → [Print Set]
1
Select a still picture (→207)
2
Use to set number of still pictures and press [MENU/SET] (up to 999
pictures)
(Repeat steps
1
and
2
when using [Multi])
Date print setting/release → Press
.
To clear all
Select [Print Set] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
When you have performed [Print Set] for pictures in a group, the setting for how many prints to
make applies to all pictures in the group, and the number of prints set and total number of prints
are shown on the print settings icon of the first picture. If the total number of pictures is 1,000 or
higher, [999+] is displayed.
Date print setting cannot be made for pictures with a [Text Stamp] applied.
Depending on the type of printer, the printer settings may take priority over camera settings.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Motion pictures
4K burst files
Pictures recorded using [Post Focus]
Still pictures recorded with the [Quality] setting [
]
225
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Protect]
Set protection to disable picture deletion. Prevents deletion of important pictures.
[Playback] → [Protect]
1
Select picture (→207)
To clear all
Select [Protect] → [Cancel] → [Yes], and then press [MENU/SET]
When you set the write-protect switch on the card to the “LOCK” position, the picture is not
erased.
The picture is erased when formatting, even if it is protected.
May not be effective when using other devices.
[Face Rec Edit]
Edit or delete the recognition information for pictures with incorrect information.
[Playback] → [Face Rec Edit] → [REPLACE] or [DELETE]
1
Use to select picture and press [MENU/SET]
2
Use to select a person and press [MENU/SET]
If [DELETE], go to step
4
.
3
Use to select the person to replace for another and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select [Yes] and press [MENU/SET]
When Face Recognition information is deleted, it cannot be restored.
Pictures for which all Face Recognition information has been deleted are not categorized in Face
Recognition during [Category Play] or [Category Selection].
Edit the Face Recognition information in group units for a picture group. (You cannot edit the
information for each picture in a group.)
You can edit only the first picture in a group.
226
SQW0721
Using Menu Functions
Menu list
[Picture Sort]
You can set the display sequence used for playing back pictures on this unit.
[Playback] → [Picture Sort]
[FILE NAME]
Displays pictures in the folder name or file name sequence. This display
format allows you to find the storage location of a picture on a card more
easily.
[DATE/TIME]
Displays pictures according to the date and time that the pictures were taken
in chronological order. When the pictures are taken using several cameras
and stored on the same card, this display format allows you to find a specific
picture more easily.
Pictures may not be displayed according to the [DATE/TIME] sequence immediately after a card
is inserted into this unit. In that case, wait a while, and the pictures will be displayed in the [DATE/
TIME] sequence.
227
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
What you can do with the Wi-Fi
®
function
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone/tablet
(→231)
Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording)
Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone
Saving pictures in the camera to a smartphone
Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services
Writing the location information on pictures in the camera
Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie according to your
preference on a smartphone
Connect easily
You can easily set up a direct connection to your smartphone without entering a password.
Displaying still pictures on a TV (→241)
Wireless printing (→246)
Sending pictures to AV device (→247)
Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV device in the home (home AV
device).
Sending pictures to a PC (→248)
Using WEB services (→250)
Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social
networking services, etc. You can receive still pictures and motion pictures on a PC or a
smartphone/tablet using the Cloud Sync. Service.
• Hereafter, this manual uses the term “smartphone” for both smartphones and tablets
unless it is necessary to distinguish between them.
228
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi Function
Before Use
• Complete the date and time settings in advance. (→28)
• To use the Wi-Fi function on this unit, a wireless access point or a destination device
equipped with the wireless LAN function is required.
Lighting of the Wi-Fi connection lamp when the Wi-Fi function is in use
Lit: When the Wi-Fi function is ON or connected by
Wi-Fi
Blinking: When sending picture data
About the [Wi-Fi] button
In this Owner’s Manual, a function button to which [Wi-Fi] is assigned is referred to as the
[Wi-Fi] button. (At the time of purchase, [Wi-Fi] is assigned to [Fn4] button in recording
mode, and [Fn1] in playback mode.)
• For details on the function button, refer to (→46).
To start up the Wi-Fi function (When in recording mode):
Touch [ ]
Touch [ ]
229
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi Function
Operations that can be performed by pressing the [Wi-Fi] button
If you press the [Wi-Fi] button when you do not have a Wi-Fi connection, the
camera enters a standby mode in which it can connect directly to the smartphone.
(→232)
• If you press the [DISP.] button at that time, you can select a destination from the history
of previous connections and quickly connect. (→264)
When the camera is connected to Wi-Fi, you can press [Wi-Fi] button and perform
the following operations.
[Terminate the Connection] Terminates the Wi-Fi connection.
[Change the Destination]
*
1
Terminates the Wi-Fi connection, and allows you to
select a different Wi-Fi connection.
[Change Settings for Sending Images]
*
2
For details (→244).
[Register the Current Destination to
Favorite]
*
1
Registering the current connection destination or the
connection method, you can easily connect with the
same connection method next time.
[Network Address] For details (→267).
*
1
This item will not be displayed if you press to send pictures to WEB services while the pictures
are displayed (→252).
*
2
This item will not be displayed if the destination for [Remote Shooting & View], [Playback on TV] or
[Send Images Stored in the Camera] is set to [Printer].
230
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Wi-Fi Function
Describing method
When selecting “[Select a destination from History]”, etc. is
described in a step, perform any of the following operations.
With cursor button operations
Use cursor button to select [Select a destination from History]
and press [MENU/SET].
With touch screen operations
Touch [Select a destination from History].
Do not remove the memory card or battery or move to an area without any reception while
sending images.
The camera cannot be used to connect to a public wireless LAN connection.
Use a IEEE802.11b, IEEE802.11g or IEEE802.11n compatible device when using a wireless
access point.
We recommend that you use a fully charged battery when you send pictures.
When sending images on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may be incurred
depending on the details of your contract.
Pictures may not be completely sent depending on radio wave conditions. If the connection is
terminated while sending pictures, pictures with missing sections may be sent.
231
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a
smartphone
You can remotely operate the camera using a smartphone.
The “Panasonic Image App” (hereafter “Image App”) must be installed on your
smartphone.
Installing the smartphone/tablet app “Panasonic Image App”
Supported OS Android™: Android 4.0 or later
iOS: iOS 7.0 or later
Installation
procedure
Connect your device to a network
(Android) Select “Google Play™ Store”
(iOS) Select “App Store”
Enter “Panasonic Image App” or “LUMIX” to search for the app
Select “Panasonic Image App” and install it
• Use the latest version.
• Supported OS versions as of October 2016. Supported OS versions may be changed
without prior notice.
• The service may not be able to be used properly depending on the type of smartphone
being used.
For the latest information on the “Image App”, refer to the support site below.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/ (This site is available in English only.)
• When downloading the app on a mobile network, high packet communication fees may
be incurred depending on the details of your contract.
• For details about the operating procedure, etc., refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu.
• If you connect the camera and smartphone over a Wi-Fi connection and run “Image
App”, [Help] may not be displayed in the “Image App” menu for some smartphones. In
such a case, disconnect the Wi-Fi connection with the camera, connect the camera to
a cellular data line such as 3G and LTE, or the Internet to display [Help] in the “Image
App” menu.
• Some of the screens and information provided in this document may be different
depending on the supported operating system and “Image App” version.
232
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Connecting to a smartphone
Connecting without using the password
You can easily establish a Wi-Fi connection on this unit without entering a password on
your smartphone.
(On the camera)
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Remote Shooting & View]
SSID
The information required for directly connecting your smartphone to
this unit (SSID) is displayed.
You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] button on
the camera.
(On your smartphone)
1
Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu
2
Select the SSID displayed on the screen of the camera
3
Start “Image App” (→231)
When the connection confirmation screen appears on the camera, select
[Yes] and press [MENU/SET]. (Only when making a connection for the
first time.)
[Wi-Fi Password] is set to [OFF] at the time of purchase. When you start a Wi-Fi
connection, be sure to verify that the device displayed on the camera’s connection
confirmation screen is really the device you want to connect to. Even if the wrong device
is displayed, you will still be connected to it if you select “Yes”.
If there seem to be other Wi-Fi enabled devices in the vicinity, we recommend that you
set [Wi-Fi Password] to [ON]. (→233, 234).
233
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Using a password to set up a connection
When [Wi-Fi Password] is set to [ON], you can strengthen security by using manual input
or a QR code for password authentication.
Preparation
(On the camera) Set [Wi-Fi Password] to [ON]. (→266)
When reading a QR Code to connect
(On the camera)
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Remote Shooting & View]
SSID and Password
QR Code
The information (QR Code, SSID and Password) required for
directly connecting your smartphone to this unit is displayed.
You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] button on
the camera.
(On your smartphone)
Start “Image App” (→231)
Select “QR code”
When the smartphone is connected to a wireless access point, it may take time to display QR
code.
(For iOS devices) A confirmation screen will be displayed. Select [OK] to proceed.
Use the “Image App” to scan the QR code displayed on the screen of the camera
If you press [MENU/SET] on the camera, the QR code will be enlarged.
For iOS devices only
Install the profile
If the smartphone is locked with a passcode, enter the passcode to unlock the smartphone.
Press the home button to close the browser
Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu
On the Wi-Fi setting screen, select the SSID displayed on the
camera
Start “Image App” (→231)
• (iOS devices) Steps
through are not required from the second
time on.
234
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Manually entering a password to set up a connection
(On the camera)
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Remote Shooting & View]
SSID and Password
QR Code
The information (QR Code, SSID and Password) required for
directly connecting your smartphone to this unit is displayed.
You can also display the information by pressing [Wi-Fi] button on
the camera.
(On your smartphone)
Turn on the Wi-Fi function in the setting menu
On the Wi-Fi setting screen, select the SSID displayed on the
camera
Enter the password displayed on the camera (For first time
connection only)
If you are using an Android device, marking the box for password display
will allow the device to display the password as you enter it.
Start “Image App” (→231)
Changing the connection method
To change the connection method, follow the steps below:
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function]
→ [New Connection] → [Remote Shooting & View]
→ [DISP.] button
or
→ [DISP.] button → [New Connection]
→ [Remote Shooting & View] → [DISP.] button
235
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
When connecting with [Via Network]
(On the camera)
Select [Via Network] and press [MENU/SET]
Connect the camera to a wireless access point by following the connection method (→260).
(On your smartphone)
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select the wireless access point you connected to the camera, and set
Start “Image App” (→231)
When connecting with [Direct]
(On the camera)
Select [Direct] and press [MENU/SET]
Select [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection]
*
, and connect the camera to the smartphone by
following the connection method (→263).
*
WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure the settings related to the
connection and security of wireless LAN devices. To check if the smartphone you are using is
compatible with WPS, refer to the instruction manual of the smartphone.
(On your smartphone)
Start “Image App” (→231)
Closing the connection
1
Set the camera to Recording Mode
Press the shutter button halfway to return to recording mode.
2
Select the camera’s menu items to terminate the Wi-Fi
connection
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function]
→ [Yes]
You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi] button
on the camera (→229).
3
On the smartphone, close “Image App”
<Using an iOS device>
From the “Image App” screen, press the home button to close the app
<Using an Android device>
From the “Image App” screen, press the back button twice to close the app
• When recording with [4K Pre-Burst] with the smartphone, terminate the connection only
after switching to 4K Burst recording by pressing [Q.MENU/ ] button on the camera.
236
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Taking pictures via a smartphone (remote recording)
1
Connect to a smartphone (→232)
2
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
Take pictures
The recorded images are saved in the camera.
Some settings are not available.
When using zoom, the camera could tilt when the lens barrel extends. Make sure to secure the
camera in place with a tripod or by other means.
This function is not available in the following cases:
Panorama Shot Mode
When using [Time Lapse Shot]
Taking a picture while jumping
When you hold your smartphone and jump, the camera’s shutter can be released automatically as the
smartphone detects the peak of the jump.
1
Operate the smartphone
[ ] → [ ] → Select the sensitivity
[ ] will be displayed on the remote recording screen of the smartphone.
We recommend that you take test pictures.
For details about the operating procedure, refer to [Help] in the “Image App”.
237
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Playing back pictures in the camera on a smartphone
1
Connect to a smartphone (→232)
Switch the
device of the
pictures to be
displayed
2
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
You can switch a device of pictures to be displayed using the icon at
the top left on the screen. Select [LUMIX] to display a picture saved
in the camera.
When the picture is touched, it is played back at a larger size.
• When playing back motion pictures, the data size is reduced during transmission of
motion pictures to “Image App”. Therefore, the picture quality may be different from the
actual motion picture that you have recorded. Depending on your smartphone and its
usage environment, you may notice degradation in the picture quality or skipping of
sound when playing back motion pictures and still pictures.
Saving pictures in the camera to a smartphone
1
Connect to a smartphone (→232)
2
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
You can switch a device of pictures to be displayed using the icon at
the top left on the screen. Select [LUMIX] to display a picture saved
in the camera.
Press and hold the picture and drag it to save it on the
smartphone
RAW still pictures, AVCHD motion pictures, MP4 motion pictures for which the [Rec Quality] size is
[4K], 4K burst files, and pictures recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be saved.
238
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Sending pictures in the camera to social networking services
1
Connect to a smartphone (→232)
Switch the
device of the
pictures to be
displayed
2
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
You can switch a device of pictures to
be displayed using the icon at the top
left on the screen. Select [LUMIX] to
display a picture saved in the camera.
Press and hold the picture and drag
it to send it to the social networking
service, etc.
The picture will be sent to the social
networking service or other WEB
services.
Adding location information to pictures in the camera from a
smartphone
You can send the location information acquired from a smartphone to the camera. After
the information is sent, you can write it on the pictures in the camera.
GPS
Starts location information recording
Start the recording
Ends location information recording
Sends and writes the location
information
• You can also use [Location Logging] in the [Playback] menu to write the sent location
information to the pictures.
• Location information that is different from the information acquired during recording may
be written. Take care regarding the following matters.
Set [Home] of [World Time] of the camera to your home area.
Once a smartphone starts recording the location information, do not change the
[Home] setting of [World Time] of the camera.
• The location information cannot be written to pictures recorded without setting [Clock
Set].
239
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Recording location information and taking pictures
Start recording the location information on your smartphone
Start “Image App” (→231)
Select [ ]
Select [ ]
Select [ Start geotagging]
Take pictures using the camera
End recording of the location information on your smartphone
Select [ Stop geotagging] to end recording of location information
Writing location information to a picture
Preparation
(On the camera) Connect to a smartphone. (→232)
Operate the smartphone
Start “Image App” (→231)
Select [ ]
Select [ ]
Select [ ] to send or write location information
Follow the messages on the screen to perform the operation.
[
] is displayed for pictures that have location information written to it.
The smartphone battery drains faster while location information is being recorded. When recording
of location information is not necessary, stop it.
For details about the operating procedure, etc., refer to [Help] in the “Image App” menu.
On the smartphone, you can set the acquisition interval of location information and check the
transfer status of location information
The location information cannot be written in the following cases:
Images recorded after location information was sent to the camera
Pictures that already have location information
Motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] format
240
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Operating the camera by connecting it to a smartphone
Combining motion pictures recorded with Snap Movie
according to your preference on a smartphone
Using a smartphone, you can combine motion pictures recorded with the camera’s [Snap
Movie] function (→158). Music can be added to motion pictures to be combined. In
addition, you can save the combined motion picture or upload it on a web service.
Record motion pictures
with [Snap Movie]
Send the recorded
motion pictures
Edit
WEB
services
Combine the motion
pictures, save the
combined motion picture,
and send it to a web
service
Combine the motion
pictures, and save the
combined motion picture
Combining motion pictures by operating a smartphone
Connect to a smartphone (→232)
Operate the smartphone
Select [ ]
Select [ ]
[Snap Movie] motion pictures with recent recording dates will be selected and automatically
sent to the smartphone.
When motion pictures with recent recording dates are not available, a screen that lets you
select motion pictures will be displayed. Select motion pictures and send them.
Operate the smartphone to edit the motion pictures
Read the [Help] in the “Image App” menu for further details on how to operate [Snap Movie] of
“Image App”.
[Snap Movie] of the “Image App” requires a smartphone that supports Android OS 4.3 or higher.
The iPhone 4 does not support [Snap Movie] of the “Image App”.
241
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Displaying still pictures on a TV
You can display still pictures on a TV that is compatible with a DLNA certified digital
media renderer (DMR) function.
Preparation
Set the TV to DLNA waiting Mode.
Read the operating instructions for your TV.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Playback on TV]
1
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→260, 263)
2
Select the device you wish to connect to
When the connection is established, the screen is displayed.
3
Take or play back still pictures on this unit
To terminate the connection, follow the steps below:
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes ]
(You can also close the connection by pressing the [Wi-Fi] button. (→229))
When you display the pictures on a TV using the Wi-Fi function, they are not output using 4K
resolution. To output pictures using 4K resolution, connect this unit to the TV using an HDMI micro
cable. (→270)
When a TV is connected to this unit, the TV screen may temporarily return to the status before the
connection. Pictures are displayed again when you take or play back pictures.
Even if [Effect] and [Sound] are set on this unit, these settings are disabled when the pictures are
played back on a TV during Slide Show playback.
Motion pictures and 4K burst files cannot be played back.
During Multi Playback, Calendar Playback, or when selecting a focus position from a picture
recorded in Post Focus, pictures displayed on the screen of the camera are not displayed on the
TV.
242
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
When sending pictures, first select [New Connection], then
select the method of sending pictures.
After you have completed connecting, you can also change
the sending settings, such as the size of pictures to be sent.
Images that can be sent
Destination JPEG RAW
MP4
*
1
AVCHD
*
1,
*
2
4K Burst File
*
1
Pictures recorded in
[Post Focus]
*
1
[Smartphone] (→245)
*
3
[PC] (→248)
[Cloud Sync. Service]
(→253)
*
3
[Web service] (→250)
*
3
[AV device] (→247)
[Printer]
*
1
(→246)
*
1
Sending by [Send Images While Recording] is not available.
*
2
Files larger than 4 GB cannot be sent.
*
3
Excluding motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K].
• Some images may not be played back or sent depending on the device.
• For more information about picture playback, see the operating instructions of the
destination device, or check the WEB service to which you will send the pictures.
[Send Images While Recording]
A picture can be automatically sent to a specified device every time you take it.
• [
] is displayed on the recording screen while connected by
[Send Images While Recording], and [ ] is displayed while
files are being sent.
• To terminate the connection, follow the steps below:
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [Yes]
11
• You can terminate the connection or change the send settings by pressing [Wi-Fi]
button. (→229)
You cannot change the settings while sending a still picture. Wait until sending is
complete.
Sending pictures
243
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures
Since the camera gives priority to recording, sending may take longer during the recording.
If you turn off the camera before you have completed sending, or if you close the Wi-Fi
connection, or in similar situations, unsent files will not be resent.
You may not be able to delete files or use the [Playback] menu while sending.
Motion pictures, 4K burst files recorded with the 4K Photo function, and pictures recorded in [Post
Focus] cannot be sent.
If you set [Time Lapse Shot], the Wi-Fi connection is terminated and you cannot use this function.
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
You can select and send recorded images.
How to select an image(s) after selecting [Single Select] or [Multi Select]
[Single Select]
Select the picture
SetSet
Select [Set]
[Multi Select]
Select the picture (repeat)
If selected again, the setting will be canceled.
2 3
4 5 6
1
OK
Select [OK]
The number of pictures that can be sent by [Multi Select] is
limited.
• To change the send settings on a screen that is displayed after the image has been
sent, press [DISP.] button. To close the connection, select [Exit].
Details of the [Playback] menu [Favorite] or [Print Set] settings will not be sent.
Some images taken with a different camera may not be able to be sent.
Images that have been modified or edited with a computer may not be able to be sent.
244
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures
Changing the settings for sending images
After you have completed connecting, you can change the sending settings, such as the
size of pictures to be sent, by pressing the [DISP.] button.
Item Description
[Size]
Resize the image to send.
[Original] / [Auto]
*
1
/ [Change]
If you select [Auto], the image size is determined by the
circumstances at the destination.
You can select the image size for [Change] from [M], [S], or [VGA].
The aspect ratio does not change.
[File Format]
*
2
[JPG] / [RAW+JPG] / [RAW]
[Delete Location Data]
*
3
Select whether to delete the location information from images before
sending them.
[ON]: Delete the location information, then send.
[OFF]: Keep the location information and send.
This operation only deletes the location information from the
images that are set to be sent. (The location information will not
be deleted from the original images stored in this unit.)
[Cloud Limit]
*
4
You can select whether to send images when the Cloud Folder runs
out of free space.
[ON]: Do not send images.
[OFF]: Delete images from the oldest ones, then send new images.
*
1
Only available when the destination is set to [Web service].
*
2
Only available when the destination is set to [PC].
*
3
Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service] or [Web service].
*
4
Only available when the destination is set to [Cloud Sync. Service].
245
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Preparation
Install “Image App” in advance. (→231)
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] / [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Smartphone]
1
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→260, 263)
(On your smartphone)
When connecting with [Via Network]
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select a wireless access point and set
Start “Image App” (→231)
When connecting with [Wi-Fi Direct] or [WPS Connection] in [Direct]
Start “Image App” (→231)
When connecting with [Manual Connection] in [Direct]
Set Wi-Fi function to “ON”
Select the SSID displayed on this unit
Start “Image App” (→231)
2
Select the device you wish to connect to
3
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
[Send Images While Recording]
4
Take a still picture (→242)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
4
Select the picture (→243)
Sending pictures to a smartphone
246
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Wireless printing
You can print out recorded still pictures wirelessly from a PictBridge (wireless
LAN-compatible)
*
printer.
*
Compliant with the DPS over IP standards.
Contact the printer manufacturers for details on PictBridge (wireless LAN-compatible) printers.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images Stored in the Camera] → [Printer]
1
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→260, 263)
2
Select a printer you want to connect
3
Select the still picture and print
Pictures are selected the same way as when connecting by USB connection cable. For details
(→279).
To terminate the connection, press [Q.MENU/
] button.
Motion pictures, 4K burst files, and pictures recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be printed.
247
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to AV device
Still pictures and motion pictures can be sent to AV devices in the home (home AV
devices), such as DLNA compatible recorders.
Wireless access point
Home AV device
Preparations
When sending a picture to AV devices, set your device to DLNA waiting Mode.
Read the operating instructions of your device for details.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] / [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [AV device]
1
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→260, 263)
2
Select the device you wish to connect to
3
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
[Send Images While Recording]
4
Take a still picture (→242)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
4
Select the picture (→243)
Sending may fail depending on the operational status of the AV device. Also, sending may take a
while.
248
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
Still pictures and motion pictures recorded by the camera can be sent to a PC.
Preparations
Turn the computer on.
Prepare folders for receiving images on the PC before sending a picture to the PC (below).
If the standard settings are changed for the workgroup on the connected PC, you must change
settings in [PC Connection] on this unit. (→266)
To create a folder that receives images
• Create a PC user account (account name (up to 254 characters) and password (up to
32 characters)) consisting of alphanumeric characters. An attempt to create a receive
folder may fail if the account includes non-alphanumeric characters.
When using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on the PC (→274)
Create a folder that receives images with “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
When not using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
(For Windows)
Supported OS: Windows 10 / Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7
Example: Windows 7
Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then right-click
Select [Properties], then enable sharing of the folder
For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system.
(For Mac)
Supported OS: OS X v10.5 to v10.11
Example: OS X v10.8
Select a folder you intend to use for receiving, then click on the items in the following
order
[File] → [Get Info]
Enable sharing of the folder
For details, refer to the operating instructions of your PC or Help on the operating system.
249
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Sending pictures to a PC
Sending pictures to a PC
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] / [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [PC]
1
Select [Via Network] or [Direct] to connect (→260, 263)
2
Select the PC you want to connect to
If the PC you want to connect to is not displayed, select [Manual Input], then enter the computer
name (for Mac, enter the NetBIOS name).
3
Select the folder you want to send to
4
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
[Send Images While Recording]
5
Take a still picture (→242)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
5
Select the picture (→243)
Folders sorted by the sent date are created in the specified folder, and pictures are saved in those
folders.
If the screen for a user account and password entry appears, enter the one you set on your PC.
If the computer name (for Mac, the NetBIOS name) contains spaces, etc., the name may not be
properly recognized. If you cannot connect, we recommend changing the computer name (for
Mac, the NetBIOS name) to a combination of 15 or less alphanumeric characters only.
If a firewall is enabled by the OS or security software, this unit may be unable to connect to the
computer.
250
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Through “LUMIX CLUB”, you can send still pictures and motion pictures to social
networking services, etc. By selecting the setting to automatically transfer still pictures
and motion pictures to [Cloud Sync. Service], you can receive the transferred still pictures
and motion pictures on a PC or a smartphone.
Wireless access point
WEB services
Cloud
synchronization
services
LUMIX CLUB
When sending images to WEB service
Preparation
You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→254) to send a picture to a WEB service.
To send images to a WEB service, you need to register the WEB service. (→251)
Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages resulting from the leakage, loss, etc.
of images uploaded on WEB services.
When uploading images to the WEB service, do not delete images from this camera, even
after they have finished sending, until you have checked that they have been properly
uploaded to the WEB service. Panasonic assumes no responsibility for the damages
resulting from the deletion of images stored in this unit.
Images uploaded to the WEB service cannot be displayed or deleted with this camera. Check
images by accessing the WEB service with your smartphone or computer.
If sending images fails, a report email outlining the failure will be sent to the email address
registered with “LUMIX CLUB”.
251
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Registering the WEB service to “LUMIX CLUB”
Check the “FAQ/Contact us” on the following site for compatible WEB services.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/lumix_faqs/
Preparation
Make sure that you have created an account on the WEB service you want to use, and have the login
information available.
1
Connect to the “LUMIX CLUB” site using a smartphone or computer
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
2
Enter your “LUMIX CLUB” login ID and password and log in to the service
3
If you have not registered your email address with “LUMIX CLUB”, register the
email address
4
Select the WEB service to be used for WEB service link settings and register it
Follow the instructions on the screen to register the service.
Sending pictures
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] / [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Web service]
1
Select [Via Network] and connect (→260)
2
Select a WEB service you want to connect
3
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
[Send Images While Recording]
4
Take a still picture (→242)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
4
Select the picture (→243)
252
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
Quickly sending pictures in the camera to WEB services
Once you send a picture, you can send pictures to the WEB service as quickly and easily
as using a smartphone, only when the environment for connecting to a wireless access
point is available.
(The instructions below assume that you are already registered to “LUMIX CLUB”
and the camera has a record of a connection to a wireless access point.)
Display the picture
Select [Yes] after pressing
(When group pictures are selected, press and then select
[Upload(Wi-Fi)] or [Upload All(Wi-Fi)].)
The same operation can be performed by touching [ ].
(When selecting a group picture, touch [ ], [ ], [ ], [ ], and
then [
], and then select [Upload(Wi-Fi)] or [Upload All(Wi-Fi)])
Select a WEB service you want to connect
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
The camera is connected to the previously used wireless access point and the pictures are sent to
the WEB service.
Step
, are not necessary when you continue to send another image.
To change the transmission setting for the picture, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
To terminate the connection, press [MENU/SET] or operate other controls to exit the playback
screen. You can also terminate the connection by pressing [Wi-Fi] button on the camera. (→229)
To change the settings for sending images or web service
Terminate the Wi-Fi connection, and follow step and onwards again.
• You can also change the send settings by pressing [Wi-Fi] button while using a Wi-Fi
connection. (→229)
If the camera has no records of connections to wireless access points that are available, a screen
that asks you to select a connection method is displayed. Select the connection method and
connect the camera to a wireless access point. (→260)
When you are not registered to “LUMIX CLUB”, a screen that asks you to acquire a new login ID is
displayed. Get a login ID and set a password. (→255)
When pictures are displayed as a group, they are all sent. When a single picture in a group is
displayed, only the picture being displayed is sent.
253
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using WEB services
When sending images to [Cloud Sync. Service]
Preparation
You need to register to “LUMIX CLUB” (→254) and configure the Cloud Sync. setting to send a picture
to a Cloud Folder. Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (→274) on a PC or “Image App” on a smartphone to
configure the Cloud Sync. settings.
About the images sent to a Cloud Folder by the use of [Cloud Sync. Service]
(Current as of October 2016)
• If you set the picture destination to [Cloud Sync. Service], sent pictures are
temporarily saved in the cloud folder, and they can be synchronized with the device in
use, such as the PC or smartphone.
• A Cloud Folder stores transferred images for 30 days (up to 1,000 pictures).
Transferred images are deleted automatically 30 days after the transfer. Furthermore,
when the number of stored images exceeds 1,000, some images may be deleted
depending on the [Cloud Limit] (→244) setting even within 30 days after the transfer.
• When the download of images from a Cloud Folder to all specified devices is
complete, images may be deleted from the Cloud Folder even within 30 days after the
transfer.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] / [Send Images Stored in the Camera]
→ [Cloud Sync. Service]
1
Select [Via Network] and connect (→260)
2
Check the send settings, and select [Set]
To change the send setting, press the [DISP.] button. (→244)
[Send Images While Recording]
3
Take a still picture (→242)
[Send Images Stored in the Camera]
3
Select the picture (→243)
254
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
About the [LUMIX CLUB]
Acquire a “LUMIX CLUB” login ID (free).
If you register this unit to the “LUMIX CLUB”, you can synchronize images between the
devices you are using, or transfer these images to WEB services.
Use the “LUMIX CLUB” when uploading pictures to WEB services.
• You can set the same “LUMIX CLUB” login ID for this unit and a smartphone. (→257)
Refer to the “LUMIX CLUB” site for details.
http://lumixclub.panasonic.net/eng/c/
Please note;
• The service may be suspended due to regular maintenance or unexpected problems,
and service contents may be changed or added to, without prior notice to the users.
• The service may be stopped in whole or in part with a reasonable period of advance
notice.
255
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Acquiring a new login ID ([New account])
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
→ [Set/Add Account] → [New account]
• Connect to the network. Proceed to the next page by selecting [Next].
• A confirmation screen will be displayed if a login ID has already been acquired for the
camera. Select [Yes] to acquire a new login ID, or [No] if you do not need to acquire a
new login ID.
1
Select the method for connecting to a wireless access point, and set (→260)
The settings screen will only appear during the first connection. Connection methods set on this
unit are stored and will be used for subsequent connections. If you want to change the wireless
access point to connect to, press the [DISP.] button, then change the connecting destination.
Proceed to the next page by selecting [Next].
2
Read through the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use and select [Agree]
You can press to switch pages.
Turn the zoom lever to the T side to enlarge the page display (x2 magnification).
If you turn the zoom lever to the W side after enlarging the page, the page returns to its original
size (no magnification).
You can use
to move the position of the area to be enlarged.
Press [Q.MENU/
] button to cancel the process without acquiring a login ID.
3
Enter the password
Enter any combination of 8 to 16 characters and numbers for the password.
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
4
Check the login ID and select [OK]
The login ID (12-digit number) will be displayed automatically.
When logging in to the “LUMIX CLUB” with a computer, you only need to enter the numbers.
A message is displayed when the connection is complete. Select [OK].
Be sure to make a note of the login ID and password.
256
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Using a previously acquired login ID/confirming and changing login ID
and password ([Set Login ID])
Preparation
To use a previously acquired login ID, confirm your ID and password.
To change the “LUMIX CLUB” password on the camera, access the “LUMIX CLUB” website from your
smartphone or PC and change the “LUMIX CLUB” password in advance.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
→ [Set/Add Account] → [Set Login ID]
• The login ID and password are displayed.
• The password is displayed as “
”.
• Close the menu if only checking the login ID.
1
Select the item you wish to change
2
Enter your login ID or password
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
Enter the new password you have created on your smartphone or PC into the camera.
257
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
To set the same login ID for the camera and the smartphone
Setting the same login ID on this unit and your smartphone is convenient for sending
images on this unit to other devices or WEB services.
When either this unit or the smartphone has acquired the login ID
Connect this unit to the smartphone (→232)
From the “Image App” menu, set the common login ID
• After connecting this unit to the smartphone, the setup screen for a common login ID
may appear when you display the playback screen. You can also set a common login
ID by following the on-screen instructions.
• This operation is not available for [Wi-Fi Direct] connection.
When this unit and the smartphone have acquired different login IDs
When you want to use the smartphone’s login ID for this unit
Change the login ID and password for this unit to those acquired by the smartphone.
When you want to use this unit’s login ID for the smartphone
Change the login ID and password for the smartphone to those acquired by this unit.
258
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
Using “LUMIX CLUB”
Check the “LUMIX CLUB” terms of use
Check the details if the terms of use have been updated.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB] → [Terms of use]
Delete your login ID and account from the “LUMIX CLUB”
Delete the login ID from the camera when transferring it to another party or disposing of it.
You can also delete your “LUMIX CLUB” account.
• Changes and other actions to login IDs can only be made to the login ID acquired with
the camera.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup] → [LUMIX CLUB]
→ [Delete account]
• The message is displayed. Select [Next].
1
Select [Yes] in the login ID delete confirmation screen
The message is displayed. Select [Next].
2
Select [Yes] on the confirmation screen for deleting the “LUMIX CLUB” account
If you want to continue using the service, selecting [No] will only delete the login ID. Exit the
menu after it is executed.
3
Select [Next]
The login ID is deleted, and then the message notifying the deletion of your account is displayed.
Select [OK].
259
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
The following types of connections are available.
[New Connection]
Connect after selecting the Wi-Fi function
and destination.
(→232, 241, 242)
[Select a destination from History]
Connect using the same settings as a
previous Wi-Fi connection.
(→264)
[Select a destination from Favorite]
Connect using settings registered to
Favorite.
When a screen similar to the one below is displayed, select a connection method.
• Example of operation for displaying a screen:
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function] → [New Connection]
→ [Send Images While Recording] → [Smartphone]
Wireless access point
Connection method Description
[Via Network] Connects through a wireless access point. (→260)
[Direct]
Your device connects directly to this unit.
(If you are out and unable to use your wireless access
point, or temporarily connecting to equipment you do not
ordinarily use, or in a similar situation, it is convenient to
make a direct connection.)
(→263)
260
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
Connecting via a wireless access point ([Via Network])
Select a connection method to the wireless access point.
• WPS refers to a function that allows you to easily configure
the settings related to the connection and security of
wireless LAN devices. To check if the wireless access
point you are using is compatible with WPS, refer to the
instruction manual of the wireless access point.
Connection method Description
[WPS (Push-Button)]
Save push button type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ with a WPS mark.
1
Press the wireless access point WPS button until it
switches to WPS Mode
Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details.
[WPS (PIN code)]
Save PIN code type wireless access point that is compatible with
Wi-Fi Protected Setup with a WPS mark.
1
On the camera screen, select the wireless access point
you are connecting to
2
Enter the PIN code displayed on the camera screen
into the wireless access point
3
Press [MENU/SET] on the camera
Refer to the wireless access point instruction manual for details.
[From List]
Select this option when you are not sure about the WPS compatibility,
or when you want to search for and connect to a wireless access
point. (→261)
261
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility
(connecting by [From List])
Search for available wireless access points.
• Confirm encryption key of the selected wireless access point if the network
authentication is encrypted.
• When connecting by [Manual Input], confirm SSID, network authentication type,
encryption type, encryption key of the wireless access point you are using.
1
Select the wireless access point you are connecting to
Pressing [DISP.] button will search for a wireless access point
again.
If no wireless access point is found, refer to “When connecting
with [Manual Input]” (→262).
2
(If network authentication is encrypted)
Enter the encryption key
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
262
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
When connecting with [Manual Input]
On the screen of step
1
of “If you are not sure about the WPS compatibility (connecting
by [From List])”, select [Manual Input] (→261)
Enter the SSID of the wireless access point you are connecting to, then select [Set]
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
Select the network authentication type
For information on network authentication, see the instruction manual of the wireless access
point.
Select the encryption type
The type of settings that can be changed may vary depending on the details of network
authentication settings.
Network authentication type Encryption types that can be set
[WPA2-PSK] / [WPA-PSK] [TKIP] / [AES]
[Common Key] [WEP]
[Open] [No Encryption] / [WEP]
(When an option other than [No Encryption] is selected)
Enter the encryption key
Check the wireless access points instruction manual and settings when saving a wireless access
point.
If no connection can be established, the wireless access point’s radio waves may be too weak.
Refer to “Message displays” (→290) and “Q&A Troubleshooting” (→296) for details.
Transmission speed may decrease, or may not be usable depending on the environment it is used
in.
263
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
Connecting directly ([Direct])
Select a connection method with which your equipment is
compatible.
• Read the operating instructions of your device for details.
Connection method Description
[Wi-Fi Direct]
1
Set the device to Wi-Fi Direct
®
mode
2
Select [Wi-Fi Direct] on the camera screen
3
On the camera screen, select the device to connect to
[WPS Connection]
[WPS (Push-Button)]
1
Select [WPS (Push-Button)]
2
Set the device to WPS mode
You can wait longer for a connection by pressing the [DISP.] button on
this unit.
[WPS (PIN code)]
1
Select [WPS (PIN code)]
2
Enter the PIN code of the device into the camera
[Manual Connection]
1
Enter the SSID and password
into the device. The SSID and
password are displayed on the
connection waiting screen of this
unit
SSID and Password
If a device to be connected is [Smartphone],
the password is not displayed. Select SSID
to connect. (→232)
264
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
Connecting quickly with the same settings as used previously
([Select a destination from History] / [Select a destination from
Favorite])
The camera keeps a History of times you used the Wi-Fi function. You can register items
in the History to Favorite.
You can easily connect with the same settings as used previously by connecting from
History or Favorite.
• If the Wi-Fi settings of the device to connect to have been changed, it may not be
possible to connect to the device.
1
Set the menu (→42)
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function]
[Select a destination from History] Connects using the same settings as used previously.
[Select a destination from Favorite] Connects using settings registered in Favorite.
2
Select the desired connection setting
Registering History items to Favorite
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function]
→ [Select a destination from History]
1
Select the item you wish to register and press
2
Enter a registration name
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text” (→49)
Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character will be treated as two characters.
265
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
About connections
Editing items registered in Favorite
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Function]
→ [Select a destination from Favorite]
1
Select the Favorite item you wish to edit and press
Item Description
[Remove from Favorite]
[Change the Order in Favorite] Select the destination.
[Change the Registered Name]
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→49)
Up to 30 characters can be entered. A double-byte character
will be treated as two characters.
Registering and saving frequently used Wi-Fi connection settings to
Favorites (→264)
The number of settings that can be saved in the history is limited.
Checking connection details of History or Favorite
When selecting History or Favorite items, you can view connection details by pressing the [DISP.]
button.
Performing [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] deletes content registered in History and Favorite.
If the device you want to connect to (smartphone, etc.) is connected to a wireless access point
other than the camera, you cannot connect the device to the camera using [Direct]. Change the
Wi-Fi settings of the device you want to connect to so that the access point to be used is set to the
camera.
You can also select [New Connection] and reconnect the devices. (→232)
When using [Select a destination from History] or [Select a destination from Favorite] to connect to
a network to which many PCs are connected, it may be difficult to make the connection because
the camera searches for previously connected equipment out of a large number of equipment
pieces. If you cannot connect, retry the connection using [New Connection].
266
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
[Wi-Fi Setup]
Configure the settings required for the Wi-Fi function.
[Wi-Fi Setup] cannot be changed when connected to Wi-Fi.
[Setup] → [Wi-Fi] → [Wi-Fi Setup]
Item Description
[Wi-Fi Password]
You can improve security
by enabling password entry
for a direct connection to a
smartphone.
[ON]: Connects the camera and a smartphone using an SSID and
password. (→233)
[OFF]: Connects the camera and a smartphone using an SSID.
(→232)
When [ON] is selected, you can also set up a connection by
scanning a QR code. (→233)
[LUMIX CLUB] Acquires or changes the “LUMIX CLUB” login ID. (→254)
[PC Connection]
You can set the workgroup.
You must connect to the same workgroup as the destination
computer when sending pictures to the computer.
(The default is set to “WORKGROUP”)
[Change Workgroup Name]:
Enter the workgroup of the connecting computer.
[Restore to Default]:
Returns settings to default settings.
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→49)
To use with a computer of the standard settings, you do not have
to change the workgroup.
[Device Name]
You can change the name
(SSID) of this unit.
Press [DISP.] button
Enter the desired device name (Up to 32 characters can be
entered)
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→49)
267
SQW0721
Wi-Fi
[Wi-Fi Setup]
Item Description
[Wi-Fi Function Lock]
To prevent incorrect operation
or use of the Wi-Fi function
by a third party and to protect
saved personal information,
it is recommended that you
protect the Wi-Fi function with
a password.
Setting a password will automatically display the password input
screen when the Wi-Fi function is used.
[Setup]: Enter any 4-digit numbers as the password.
[Cancel]
For details on how to enter characters, refer to “Entering Text”
(→49)
Make a copy of password. If you forget the password, you can
reset it with [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu, however
other settings will also be reset. (excluding [LUMIX CLUB])
[Network Address]
Displays the MAC address and
IP address of this unit.
A “MAC Address” is a unique address that is used to identify
network equipment.
“IP address” refers to a number that identifies a PC connected to
a network such as the Internet. Usually, the addresses for homes
are automatically assigned by the DHCP function such as a
wireless access point. (Example: 192.168.0.87)
[Approved Regulations] The authentication number is displayed.
268
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures
Viewing 4K motion pictures
Viewing on TV screen
When you connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV and play
back a motion picture recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K],
you can enjoy high-resolution 4K motion pictures. Although
resolution output will be lower, you can also play back 4K
motion pictures by connecting to a high-definition TV and other
devices that do not have 4K support.
Preparations
Set [HDMI Mode] (→203) to [AUTO] or [4K].
When connecting to a TV that does not support 4K motion picture, select [Auto].
Connect this unit to a 4K-compatible TV using an HDMI micro cable and display the
playback screen (→270)
When the [VIERA Link] setting on the camera is set to [ON] and the camera is connected to
a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television (VIERA), the television automatically
switches its input and the playback screen is displayed. For details (→272).
When you have motion pictures recorded with [Rec Format] set to
[MP4] and their size set to [4K] in [Rec Quality], you can also play
them back by inserting the card into the SD card slot of a TV that
supports motion pictures in 4K.
Read the operating instructions for the TV.
Viewing 4K motion pictures on a PC screen
To play back motion pictures recorded with [Rec Quality] of [4K] on a
PC, use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (→274).
• To play back and edit 4K motion pictures, a high-performance PC
environment is required.
• For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
(PDF).
269
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Enjoying 4K motion pictures
Storing 4K motion pictures
Storing 4K motion pictures on your PC
For details (→273).
Storing 4K motion pictures on a DVD
You cannot transfer or copy motion pictures recorded in [Rec Quality] with [4K] to a
Blu-ray disc or DVD using a Panasonic recorder. (Current as of October 2016)
You can use the software “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (→274) to convert the file size of a motion
picture to a smaller size or copy it to a DVD.
• For details, refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF).
270
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
You can view pictures on a TV screen by connecting your camera to your TV with the
HDMI micro cable.
Preparation
Turn off both camera and TV.
1
Connect camera to TV
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong
direction, the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation.) Also, do not
insert into the wrong socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
HDMI micro cable
Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not comply with
the HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
[HDMI] socket
To HDMI video/audio input socket
2
Turn on the TV and switch the TV input source to match the
connection socket
3
Turn on the camera and press [ ] (Playback) button
271
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
Bars may appear at the sides or at the top and bottom of the screen, depending on the aspect
ratio setting.
Change the screen mode on your TV if the picture is displayed with the top or bottom cut off.
Check the [HDMI Mode]. (→203)
To play back 24p motion pictures, set [HDMI Mode] to [AUTO]. Otherwise, the picture is not output
at 24 frames per second.
Pictures are not displayed on the camera screen.
HDMI output will be canceled if a USB connection cable (supplied) is connected simultaneously.
Read the operating instructions for the TV.
The recorded pictures can be played back on a TV with an SD Memory Card
slot
Proper playback (aspect ratio) will be dependent on the TV used for viewing.
The file format of the motion pictures that can be played back differs depending on the TV model.
You may not be able to play back panorama pictures. Also you cannot perform automatic scrolling
playback of panorama pictures.
For cards compatible with playback, refer to the operating instructions of the TV.
272
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Viewing on TV screen
VIERA Link (HDMI) (HDAVI Control™)
What is VIERA Link (HDMI)?
VIERA Link is a function that automatically links this camera to VIERA Link-
compatible devices by connecting HDMI micro cables for enabling easy operation
with the VIERA remote control. (Some operations are not available.)
VIERA Link (HDMI) is an exclusive Panasonic function added to the industry-
standard HDMI control functions known as HDMI CEC (Consumer Electronics
Control). Operation is not guaranteed when connecting with non-Panasonic HDMI
CEC-compatible devices. Refer to your product manual to verify compatibility with
VIERA Link (HDMI).
This camera supports VIERA Link (HDMI) Version 5. This is the Panasonic standard
that also supports previous Panasonic VIERA Link devices.
Preparation
Set [VIERA Link] to [ON] (→203).
1
Connect the camera to a VIERA Link (HDMI)-compatible Panasonic television
(VIERA) with an HDMI micro cable (→270)
2
Turn on the camera and press [ ] (Playback) button
3
Operate with the remote control for the TV
Turning the unit OFF
• The camera can also be turned off when the television is turned off with the remote
control.
Automatic input select
• When the camera and TV are connected by HDMI micro cable, the camera is
turned ON, and the camera’s [
] (Playback) button is pressed, the television input
automatically switches to the camera’s screen. The television can also be switched on
via the camera from Standby Mode (if “Power on link” on the television is set to “on”).
Operations via the camera buttons will be limited.
To play back the audio of the motion pictures in a slide show, set the [Sound] in the Slide Show
setting screen to [AUTO] or [Audio].
Use a “High Speed HDMI micro cable” with the HDMI logo. Cables that do not comply with the
HDMI standards will not work.
“High Speed HDMI micro cable” (Type D-Type A plug, up to 2 m (6.6 feet) long)
If VIERA Link (HDMI) does not function correctly (→298)
273
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures
on your PC
Still/motion pictures can be copied from the camera to your computer by connecting the
two together.
• Some computers can read directly from the camera’s memory card.
For details, see the instruction manual for your computer.
Computer specifications
You can connect the camera to a computer that can detect a mass storage device (device
that stores a large volume of data).
• Windows: Windows 10 / Windows 8.1 / Windows 8 / Windows 7
• Mac: OS X v10.5 - v10.11
Some motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] may not be scanned correctly by
copying a file or folder
When using Windows, be sure to use the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software (→274) to copy motion
pictures recorded in [AVCHD].
When using Mac, you can copy motion pictures recorded in [AVCHD] using “iMovie”. Note, however,
that it may not be possible to copy pictures depending on the picture quality settings.
(For details about iMovie, please contact Apple Inc.)
274
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Downloading software
If you wish to play back or edit pictures on a PC, download software from the supplier’s
website and install it on your PC.
PHOTOfunSTUDIO 9.9 PE
You can capture still pictures or motion pictures to your PC, or organize captured pictures
by categorizing by recording date, model name of the digital camera used to record, etc.
You can also correct still pictures, edit motion pictures, or write to DVD.
Check the website below to download/install the software.
The software is available for download until the end of October 2021.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/soft/download/d_pfs99pe.html
Operating environment
Supported OS
Windows
®
10 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows
®
8.1 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows
®
8 (32-bit/64-bit)
Windows
®
7 (32-bit/64-bit) SP1
CPU
Windows
®
10
Pentium
®
4 2.8 GHz or higher
Windows
®
8.1
Windows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Display 1024×768 pixels or more (1920×1080 pixels or more recommended)
RAM
Windows
®
10
1 GB or more (32-bit) / 2 GB or more (64-bit)
Windows
®
8.1
Windows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Free hard disk
space
450 MB or more for installing software
• To edit 4K motion pictures, you need the 64-bit versions of Windows 10,
Windows 8.1, Windows 8, or Windows 7.
• “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” is not compatible with Mac.
• Refer to the operating instructions of “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” (PDF) for further
information about the operating environment.
275
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
SILKYPIX Developer Studio SE
This software develops and edits RAW file pictures. Edited pictures can be saved in a file
format such as JPEG or TIFF that can be displayed on a PC, etc.
Check the website below to download/install the software.
http://www.isl.co.jp/SILKYPIX/english/p/
Operating environment
Supported OS
Windows
®
10
Windows
®
8.1
Windows
®
8
Windows
®
7
Mac
®
OS X v10.6 - v10.11
• For details on the operating environment and how to use the SILKYPIX Developer
Studio SE, refer to the “Help” or the Ichikawa Soft Laboratory’s support website.
LoiLoScope 30 day full trial version
(Windows 10 / 8.1 / 8 / 7)
Motion pictures can be edited easily.
Check the website below to download/install the software.
http://loilo.tv/product/20
• For more information on how to use LoiLoScope and its operating environment, read
the LoiLoScope manual available for download at the website.
• “LoiLoScope” is not compatible with Mac.
To download the software, the PC must be connected to the Internet.
It may take time to download the software in some communication environments.
276
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Copying still pictures and motion pictures
Preparations
Install “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” on your computer before starting the copying procedure. (→274)
Turn on the camera and computer.
1
Connect camera to computer
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction,
the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation.) Also, do not insert into the wrong
socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one.
[Access]
Do not disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) while [Access] is displayed.
[USB/CHARGE] socket
USB connection cable (supplied)
2
Use to select [PC] and press [MENU/SET]
If you set the [USB Mode] (→202) to [PC] in the [Setup] menu in advance, the camera will be
automatically connected to the PC without displaying the [USB Mode] selection screen.
3
Use “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” to copy pictures to your computer
Do not delete or move copied files and folders using Windows Explorer or other browsers.
Otherwise, you will not be able to play back or edit the files using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”.
277
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures on your PC
Copying to your computer without using “PHOTOfunSTUDIO”
You can save pictures to use on your computer by dragging and dropping folders and
files into separate folders on your computer.
The card of this unit contains the following files (folder structure).
*
2
Windows
Drive (“LUMIX”) is
displayed in “Computer”.
Mac
Drive (“LUMIX”) is
displayed on the desktop.
DCIM (Still/motion pictures)
100_PANA (Up to 999 pictures/folder)
Folder number
P1000001.JPG
*
1
File number
P1000999.JPG
101_PANA
999_PANA
MISC (DPOF files, Favorite)
PRIVATE
AVCHD (Motion pictures in AVCHD)
Color Space P: sRGB
_: AdobeRGB
Card
*
1
.JPG: Still pictures
.RW2: Still pictures recorded in RAW file
.MP4: [MP4] Motion Pictures
*
2
New folders are created in the following cases:
When there is a picture with file number 999 inside the folder.
When using cards already containing the same folder number (for example, pictures taken with
other cameras, etc.).
When recording after performing [No.Reset]. (→205)
Before inserting or removing a card, turn the camera off and disconnect the USB connection
cable. Otherwise, data may be destroyed.
Use a battery with sufficient battery power or the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
When the battery begins to run out during communication, a warning beep sounds. Remove the
USB connection cable safely. Otherwise, data may be destroyed.
278
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Storing recorded still pictures and motion pictures in
the recorder
If you insert a card that has pictures recorded with this camera into
a Panasonic recorder, you can dub the content to a Blu-ray Disc or
DVD etc.
• The method of importing still pictures and motion pictures recorded
in this unit to other devices will vary depending on the file format
(JPEG, RAW, AVCHD, or MP4).
• See the instruction manual for the recorder for details for copying and playing back.
279
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Printing
You can connect directly to a PictBridge-compatible printer for printing.
Preparations
Adjust the print quality or other settings on your printer, as needed.
Turn on the camera and printer.
1
Connect camera to printer
Check the plug direction and insert it straight in. (If the cable is inserted in the wrong direction,
the plug could become deformed and cause faulty operation.) Also, do not insert into the wrong
socket. Doing so may cause damage to this unit.
Do not use any other USB connection cables except the supplied one. Using cables other than
the above may cause a malfunction.
[ ]
Do not disconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) when the cable disconnection icon
[
] is displayed (may not be displayed with some printers).
[USB/CHARGE] socket
USB connection cable (supplied)
2
Use to select [PictBridge(PTP)] and press [MENU/SET]
3
Use to select a picture and press [MENU/SET]
4
Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET]
(Print settings (→281))
280
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Printing
Printing multiple pictures
Multiple pictures are printed at one time.
1
Press to select [Multi Print] in step
3
of “Printing” (→279)
2
Use to select the item and press [MENU/SET]
[Multi Select]
Scroll between pictures with , select pictures to print with
[MENU/SET] (Press [MENU/SET] again to release selection.)
Use to select [OK], and press [MENU/SET]
[Select All] Print all pictures.
[Print Set (DPOF)] Print pictures selected in [Print Set]. (→224)
[Favorite] Print pictures selected as [Favorite]. (→223)
3
Use to select [Print start] and press [MENU/SET]
(Print settings (→281))
The group pictures are displayed one by one instead of all pictures at the same time.
Use a battery with sufficient battery power or the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional).
When the battery begins to run out during communication, a warning beep sounds. Cancel printing
and disconnect USB connection cable (supplied).
Before inserting or removing a card, turn the camera off and disconnect the USB connection
cable.
Some printers can print directly from the camera’s memory card. For details, see the manual for
your printer.
An orange “●” displayed during printing indicates an error message.
Print may be divided into several pictures if printing a large amount of pictures. (Remaining sheets
display may differ from the number of pictures set for printing.)
Motion pictures, 4K burst files, and pictures recorded with [Post Focus] cannot be printed.
Still pictures recorded in a RAW file cannot be printed. (The still pictures recorded in JPEG file
format at the same time as the RAW file can be printed.)
281
SQW0721
Connecting with other devices
Printing
Making print settings on the camera
Setting options include the number of printed pictures and their size. Make settings before
selecting [Print start].
[Print with Date] [ON] / [OFF]
[Num.of prints] Set number of pictures (up to 999 pictures)
[Paper Size] Sets the paper size.
[Page Layout]
Sets whether or not to add borders and how many pictures to be printed on
each sheet of paper.
If the printer does not support date printing, the date cannot be printed on the picture.
When setting [Print with Date] to [ON], check the date printing settings on the printer (printer
settings may be prioritized).
Items may not be displayed if incompatible with printer.
To print to paper sizes/layouts not supported by this camera, set to [ ] and make settings on the
printer. (Consult your printer’s operating manual.)
Even with completed [Print Set] settings, dates may not be printed, depending on the shop or
printer used.
Printing with date and text
Time and date can be set to be printed on the picture when taking the picture by
activating the [Text Stamp] function in the [Playback] menu. (→219)
Printing date without [Text Stamp]
Printing in store:
Only recording date can be printed. Request date printing in store.
• Making [Print Set] (→224) settings on the camera in advance allows settings for
numbers of copies and date printing to be designated before giving the card to the
store.
• You cannot request a store to print the characters entered for [Age] or [Name] of [Profile
Setup] or [Face Recog.], [Travel Date], [Location], and [Title Edit].
Using computer:
Print settings for recording date and text information can be made using
“PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software (→274).
Using printer:
Recording date can be printed by setting [Print Set] on the camera, or by setting [Print
with Date] (→281) to [ON] when connecting to a printer compatible with date printing.
282
SQW0721
Others
Optional accessories
Using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional)
instead of the battery
By using the AC adaptor (optional) and DC coupler (optional), you can record and play
back without worrying about the remaining battery charge.
The optional DC coupler can only be used with the designated Panasonic AC adaptor
(optional).
Always use a genuine Panasonic AC adaptor (optional).
Also read the AC adaptor and DC coupler operating instructions.
283
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
• The information displayed, such as histograms, magnifications, and numeric values, are
only for the purpose of reference.
In recording
Recording mode (→34)
Custom Set (→85)
[Photo Style] (→170)
[Flash] (→146, 148)
60p
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→151)
[Snap Movie] (→158)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)/
[Picture Size] (→174)
Image size (Panorama Shot
Mode) (→69)
Picture effect (Filter)
adjustment display (→79, 172)
EXPS
Types of picture effects (Filter)
(→172)
Card (displayed only during
recording) (→25)
XXhXXmXXs
Elapsed recording time
*
1
(→149)
Simultaneous recording
indicator (→157)
[Peaking] (→192)
[Highlight Shadow] (→176)
[HDR] (→178)/[iHDR] (→54)
[Multi Exp.] (→179)
Electronic shutter (→180)
Overheat indicator (→293)
60
p
284
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
[Quality] (→174)
120fps [High Speed Video] (→83)
AFS AFF AFC MF
[AFS/AFF/AFC] (→88)/
MF (→100)
Focus Bracket (→132)
AF Mode (→89)
[Pull Focus] (→160)
[Face Recog.] (→183)
AFL AF Lock (→102)
Burst (→127)
[4K PHOTO] (→110)
[Post Focus] (→121)
[Self Timer] (→129)
Remaining battery (→23)
Macro recording (→99)
[Level Shot] (→187)
[Stabilizer] (→138)
Jitter alert (→138)
Recording state (Flashes red.)
(→149)/
Focus (Lights green.) (→33)
Focus (Under low illumination)
(→87)
Focus (Starlight AF) (→87)
Wi-Fi connection status
Histogram (→193)
Name
*
2
(→186)
Travel elapsed days
*
3
(→199)
Age in years/months
*
2
(→186)
Location
*
3
(→199)
Current date/time
*
3
Travel destination setting
*
3
: (→198)
Exposure meter (→195)
Zoom (→142)
AF area (→87, 95)
Spot metering target (→175)
[Center Marker] (→193)
[Self Timer] (→129)
[Silent Mode] (→189)
AEL AE Lock (→102)
[Metering Mode] (→41, 175)
Program Shift (→61)
1.4 Aperture value (→33)
Aperture Bracket (→132)
60 Shutter speed (→33)
Exposure compensation value
(→103)
Exposure Bracket (→131)
Brightness (exposure)
(→55, 81)
Manual Exposure Assist (→65)
ISO sensitivity (→104)
285
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
*
1
[h], [m] and [s] indicate “hour”, “minute” and “second”.
*
2
This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on if the [Profile Setup] setting is
set.
*
3
This is displayed for about 5 seconds when the camera is turned on, after setting the clock and after
switching from Playback Mode to Recording mode.
Function buttons (→47)
(→55)
(→56)
(→81)
(→84)
Coloring (→55)
Defocus control function
(→56, 81)
Brightness (exposure)
(→55, 81)
Type of defocus ([Miniature
Effect]) (→77)
[One Point Color] (→78)
[Sunshine] (→78)
Picture effect (Filter)
adjustment display
(→79, 172)
Picture effects ON or OFF
(→172)
Picture effects (Filter)
(→172)
Shutter speed (→33)
ISO sensitivity (→104)
[Dial Guide] (→195)
White Balance Bracket (→109)
White Balance Fine Adjustment
(→108)
White Balance (→106)
Coloring (→55)
98
Number of recordable pictures
(→26)
RXXmXXs
Available recording time
*
1
(→27)
Touch tab (→197)
Touch zoom (→143)
Touch Shutter (→40)
[Touch AE] (→41)
[Peaking] (→192)
Self Shot Mode (→57)
286
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
In playback
Playback Mode (→210)
Protected picture (→225)
Number of prints (→224)
With location information
(→211, 239)
Favorites (→223)
Cable disconnect prohibit icon
(→279)
Motion picture playback
(→162)
Panorama picture playback
(→71)
Continuous playback of burst
picture group (→166)
Save pictures from the 4K
burst file (→117)
Save a picture from pictures
recorded using [Post Focus]
(→123)
Continuous playback of Time
Lapse Shot picture group
(→166)
Continuous playback of stop
motion animation group
(→166)
Group pictures recorded using
Focus Bracket (→166)
Text stamped display (→219)
XXhXXmXXs
Elapsed playback time
*
1
Icon indicating the presence of
a marker (→118, 119)
4K Photo (4K burst file) (→110)
[Post Focus] (→121)
[Focus Stacking] (→124)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)/
[Picture Size] (→174)
60p
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→151)
[Snap Movie] (→158)
[Quality] (→174)
120fps [High Speed Video] (→83)
Remaining battery (→23)
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
Wi-Fi connection status
15 pic. Number of group pictures
XXhXXmXXs
Motion picture recording time
*
1
(→162)
15 pic.15 pic.
1ST DAY
1ST DAY
11 months 20 days
11 months 20 days
287
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
Clear Retouch completed icon
(→217)
Acquiring information icon
Playback (Motion Pictures)
(→162)
1ST DAY
Travel elapsed days (→199)
Upload (Wi-Fi) icon (→252)
Burst Picture Group Display
(→167)
Focus Bracket Group Display
(→167)
[Time Lapse Shot] Picture
Group Display (→167)
Display for the Stop Motion
Animation Group (→167)
Submenu icon (→252)
[Silent Mode] (→189)
11 months 20 days
Age in years/months
(→184, 186)
Multi Playback (→164)
Delete (→168)
Name
*
2
(→184, 186)
Location
*
2
(→199)
Title
*
2
(→218)
Recording information
288
SQW0721
Others
List of monitor display
Histogram (→38)
Recording information
1/98 Picture number/Total pictures
100-0001 Folder/File number (→277)
*
1
[h], [m] and [s] indicate “hour”, “minute” and “second”.
*
2
It is displayed in order of [Title], [Location], [Name] ([Baby1]/[Baby2], [Pet]), [Name] ([Face Recog.]).
Histogram display
100-00011/98
R
G
B
Y
Recording information
[Stabilizer] (→138)
[i.Dynamic] (→177)
[HDR] (→178)/[iHDR] (→54)
[i.Resolution] (→177)
Recording date/time
World time (→198)
[Aspect Ratio] (→173)/
[Picture Size] (→174)
60p
[Rec Format]/[Rec Quality]
(→151)
120fps [High Speed Video] (→83)
[Quality] (→174)
[Color Space] (→183)
4K Photo (4K burst file) (→110)
[Post Focus] (→121)
[Focus Stacking] (→124)
100-0001 Folder/File number (→277)
Detailed information display
100-0001
AM10:00 DEC. 1.2016
289
SQW0721
Others
Message displays
The following explains the meaning of major messages displayed on the monitor, and
how to respond to them.
Memory cards
[Memory Card Error] [Format this card?]
Save needed data on a computer or other device, and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26)
Try with a different card.
[Read Error] / [Write Error] [Please check the card]
Check whether card has been inserted correctly (→24).
Turn off the camera and remove the card. Reinsert the card and turn the camera on again.
Try with a different card.
[Motion recording was cancelled due to the limitation of the writing speed of the card]
The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion
picture. 4K photo recording requires a card that meets a particular speed class rating. Use a card
that meets the rating. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to
“About motion picture/4K photo recording and speed class ratings” (→25).
If recording stops even when using a card of the recommended speed class (→25), the data writing
speed has dropped. If this happens, we recommend backing up the data on the memory card and
formatting it (→26). Depending on the type of the card, recording may stop in the middle.
[Memory Card Error] [This memory card cannot be used]
Use a compatible card. (→25)
Battery
[This battery cannot be used]
Use a genuine Panasonic battery. Consult the dealer or your nearest Service Center if display still
remains.
Wipe any dirt away from the battery terminal.
290
SQW0721
Others
Message displays
Wi-Fi function
[Failed to connect wireless access point] / [Connection failed] / [No destination found]
The wireless access point information set on this unit is wrong. Check the authentication type,
encryption type, and encryption key. (→261)
Radio waves from other devices may block the connection to a wireless access point. Check other
devices that are connected to the wireless access point and devices that use the 2.4 GHz band.
[Connection failed. Please retry in a few minutes.] / [Network disconnected. Transfer stopped.]
Radio waves from the wireless access point are getting weak. Perform the connection closer to the
wireless access point.
Depending on the wireless access point, connection may be automatically disconnected after
specific time has passed. Reconnect the connection again.
[Connection failed]
Change the access point to connect to in the smartphone Wi-Fi settings to this camera.
[Cannot connect to server]
If a message is displaying asking to update the root certificate, agree to update the root certificate.
Others
[Some pictures cannot be deleted] [This picture cannot be deleted]
Non-DCF pictures (→161) cannot be deleted. Save needed data on a computer or other device,
and then use [Format] on the camera. (→26)
[Cannot be set on this picture]
[Print Set], [Title Edit], [Text Stamp], and other functions cannot be used for pictures that are not
compliant with the DCF standard (→161).
[Please turn camera off and then on again] [System Error]
Turn the camera on again. (Consult the dealer or your nearest Service Center if display still
remains.)
291
SQW0721
Others
Q&A
Troubleshooting
Try checking these items (→291 - 299) first.
If the problem persists,
Performing [Reset] in the [Setup] menu may resolve the issue (→205). (Note that
except for some items such as [Clock Set], all settings are returned to their values at
the time of purchase.)
Also, see the Panasonic support site for the latest support information.
http://panasonic.jp/support/global/cs/dsc/
(This site is available in English only.)
Battery, power
The charging lamp blinks.
Charging is being performed in a place with extremely high or low temperature.
Reconnect the USB connection cable (supplied) and retry charging in a place where ambient
temperature is 10 °C to 30 °C (50 °F to 86 °F) (temperature conditions also apply to the battery
itself).
Charging is not possible if the power supply capacity of the computer is low.
Camera does not work even if the camera is turned on. Camera switches off as soon as the
camera is turned on.
Battery needs recharging.
Charge the battery. (→19)
This unit is turned off automatically.
[Economy] is activated. (→202)
The battery runs down quickly.
[4K PHOTO] is set to [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]).
When [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]) has been selected, the battery drains faster.
Select [
] ([4K Pre-Burst]) only when recording.
The Wi-Fi connection has been on for a long time.
The battery is used up faster with a Wi-Fi connection. Turn off the camera as often as possible
using [Economy] (→202) or other methods.
292
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Recording
Cannot record pictures. The shutter will not operate immediately when the shutter button is
pressed.
When [Focus/Release Priority] is set to [FOCUS], the camera will not record until proper focusing is
achieved. (→191)
Recorded pictures look white.
Lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.).
Turn the camera off and clean the lens surface with a soft dry cloth.
Recorded pictures are too bright/too dark.
AE Lock (→102) is set inappropriately.
Some pictures are taken when I press the shutter button just once.
Cancel the following settings:
[Simultaneous record w/o filter] (→173)
Drive Mode (→126)
[Bracket] recording (→130)
Focus not aligned correctly.
Subject outside of focus range.
[Focus/Release Priority] is set to [RELEASE]. (→191)
[Shutter AF] is set to [OFF]. (→190)
AF Lock (→102) is set inappropriately.
If there are fingerprints or dirt on the lens, the focus may be set to the lens and not the subject.
Recorded pictures are blurred. The stabilizer function ineffective.
Shutter speed is slower in dark locations and the stabilizer function is less effective.
Use a tripod and the self-timer when using a slower shutter speed (→129).
Recorded pictures appear coarse, or there is interference.
We recommend trying the following methods.
Lower ISO sensitivity (→104).
Either adjust [Noise Reduction] of [Photo Style] to a higher setting or set each item other than
[Noise Reduction] to a lower setting. (→171)
Set [Long Shtr NR] to [ON]. (→182)
Subject appears skewed in pictures.
If you take a picture of a moving subject in the electronic shutter mode, motion picture recording
mode, or 4K photo recording mode, the subject in the picture may be skewed in some cases.
This is characteristic of MOS sensors which serve as the camera’s pickup sensors. This is not a
malfunction.
293
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Striping or flicker may appear under lighting such as fluorescent lighting and LED lighting
fixture.
This is characteristic of MOS sensors which serve as the camera’s pickup
sensors. This is not a malfunction.
If you are taking still pictures using the electronic shutter, the striping may be
reduced by setting a slower shutter speed. (→63)
When noticeable flicker or striping is seen under lighting such as a fluorescent
or LED lighting fixture in the motion picture recording mode, you can reduce
the flicker or striping by setting up [Flkr Decrease] (→188) and fixing the
shutter speed. It is possible to select a shutter speed from [1/50], [1/60],
[1/100], or [1/120]. You can set the shutter speed manually in the Creative
Video Mode. (→82)
Brightness or coloring of recorded picture different from real life.
When recording under fluorescent or LED lighting fixture etc., increasing the shutter speed may
introduce slight changes to brightness and color. These are a result of the characteristics of the
light source and do not indicate a malfunction.
When recording subjects in extremely bright locations or recording under fluorescent lighting, LED
lighting fixture, mercury lamp, sodium lighting etc., the colors and screen brightness may change or
horizontal striping may appear on the screen.
4K photo recording stops before finishing.
When the ambient temperature is high or recording of the 4K Photo function is performed
continuously, the camera may display [
] and stop the recording. Wait until the camera cools
down.
294
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Motion Picture
Cannot record motion pictures.
When a large capacity card is used, you may not be able to take a picture for a while after you turn
on the camera.
Motion picture recording stops midway.
When the ambient temperature is high or motion picture is recorded continuously, the camera may
display [
] and stop the recording. Wait until the camera cools down.
The speed class of a required card varies depending on [Rec Format] and [Rec Quality] of a motion
picture. Be sure to use a card of the recommended speed class. For details, refer to “About motion
picture/4K photo recording and speed class ratings” (→25).
Sometimes focus adjustment with Auto Focus mode is difficult while recording 4K motion
pictures.
This may occur when taking a picture by reducing the Auto Focus speed in order to adjust the
focus at high precision. This is not a malfunction.
A noise, such as a clicking or buzzing noise, is recorded on a motion picture. Audio is
recorded at low volumes.
With recording in a quiet environment, the sound of aperture, focus and other actions may be
recorded in motion pictures. This is not a malfunction. The focus operation during recording of
motion pictures can be set to [OFF] in [Continuous AF] (→153).
If you block the microphone with your fingers while motion pictures are being recorded, the audio
may be recorded at a low volume or may not be recorded at all. In this case, the camera may pick
up the lens operating sounds more easily.
Operating sounds are recorded in a motion picture.
Use of [Silent Operation] is recommended if you are concerned about operational sounds. (→84)
Flash
No flash emitted.
The flash becomes unavailable in the following cases.
The flash is closed. (→144)
Set [Shutter Type] to [AUTO] or [MSHTR]. (→180)
Set [Silent Mode] to [OFF]. (→189)
295
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Monitor
The monitor is turned off although the camera is turned on.
If no operations are performed during the set time period [Auto Monitor Off] (→202) is activated,
and the monitor turns off.
It may flicker for an instant or the brightness of the screen may change significantly for an
instant.
This occurs due to the aperture of the lens changing when the shutter button is pressed halfway, or
when the brightness of the subject changes. This is not a malfunction.
Playback
Cannot view pictures. There are no recorded pictures.
A card is not inserted in the camera.
Has the file name of the picture been changed on a computer? If so, it cannot be played back on
the camera.
It is recommended to use the “PHOTOfunSTUDIO” software (→274) to write pictures from PC
to card.
Set [Playback Mode] to [Normal Play]. (→210)
Red areas in pictures appear blackened.
When the digital red-eye correction ([
], [ ]) is operating, red areas may be blackened.
We recommend closing the built-in flash, setting the flash mode to [
], or turning [Red-Eye
Removal] to [OFF] before recording. (→181)
296
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Wi-Fi function
It cannot connect to the wireless LAN. Radio waves get disconnected. Wireless access point
is not displayed.
General tips for using a Wi-Fi connection
Use within the communication range of the wireless LAN network.
Is any device, such as microwave oven, cordless phone, etc., that uses 2.4 GHz frequency
operated nearby?
Radio waves may get interrupted when used simultaneously. Use them sufficiently away from
the device.
When the battery indicator is flashing red, the connection with other equipment may not start or the
connection may be disrupted. (A message such as [Communication error] is displayed.)
When this unit is placed on a metal table or shelf, the connection may not be established easily.
Use the camera away from metal surfaces.
About a wireless access point
Check if the wireless access point to connect is in operating state.
Check the radio wave condition of the wireless access point.
Perform the connection closer to the wireless access point.
Move the location or change the angle of the wireless access point.
It may not display even if the radio waves exist depending on the setting of the wireless access
point.
Turn off the wireless access point and then turn it back on.
Is the network SSID of the wireless access point set not to broadcast?
It may not be detected when it is set not to broadcast. Enter and set the network SSID. (→261)
Alternatively, set the network SSID of the wireless access point to broadcast.
This unit is not displayed in the Wi-Fi setting screen of the smartphone.
Try switching the ON/OFF of the Wi-Fi function in the Wi-Fi settings of the smartphone.
I am having a problem connecting to my Windows 8 PC. The user name and password are not
recognized.
Depending on the OS version, on Windows 8, for example, there are two types of user account
(local account/Microsoft account).
Be sure to set the local account and use the user name and password for the local account.
297
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
The Wi-Fi connection is not recognizing my PC.
The camera cannot be connected to Mac computer/Windows PC via Wi-Fi connection.
By default, the Wi-Fi connection uses the default workgroup name of “WORKGROUP”. If the name
of the workgroup has been changed, it will not be recognized.
Select [PC Connection] then [Change Workgroup Name] in the [Wi-Fi Setup] to change the
workgroup name to match that of your PC. (→266)
Please confirm login name and password are correctly typed.
When the system time of Mac computer or Windows PC connected to a camera differs severely
from that of the camera, the camera cannot be connected to the computer or PC in some OSs.
Please confirm clock set and world time of the camera matches with time, date and time zone in
Windows PC or Mac computer. When both settings do not match severely, please match them.
Images cannot be transmitted to the WEB service.
Confirm that the login information (login ID/user name/email address/password) is correct.
It takes time to transmit an image to the WEB service.
Transmission of the image fails midway. There is an image that could not be transmitted.
Is the size of the image too large?
Transmit after dividing the motion picture with [Video Divide] (→220).
Reduce the image size at [Size] (→244), and then send.
It may take longer time to transmit when distance to the wireless access point is far.
Transmit closer to the wireless access point.
File format of the picture that can be sent differs depending on the destination. (→242)
I have forgotten the password for the Wi-Fi.
Execute the [Reset Wi-Fi Settings] in the [Setup] menu. (→205)
However, the information you have set on the [Wi-Fi Setup] will be reset.
298
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
TV, computer, printer
No image appears on TV. Image blurred or not colored.
Not connected correctly (→270).
The television has not been switched to auxiliary input.
VIERA Link (HDMI) is not working.
Is the camera’s [VIERA Link] setting set to [ON]? (→203)
Check the VIERA Link (HDMI) settings on the device you are connecting to.
Turn the camera off and on again.
Cannot communicate with the computer.
Set [USB Mode] to [PC] (→202, 276).
Turn the camera off and then on again.
Computer does not recognize card. (When using an SDXC Memory Card)
Check whether your computer is compatible with SDXC Memory Cards.
http://panasonic.net/avc/sdcard/information/SDXC.html
A message prompting you to format the card may appear when you connect it. Do not format the
card.
If the [Access] indicator on the screen does not go off, turn the camera off before disconnecting the
USB connection cable.
Cannot print when connecting to printer.
Printer not compatible with PictBridge.
Set [USB Mode] to [PictBridge(PTP)] (→202, 279).
The edges of pictures are cut off when printing.
Release any trimming or edgeless printing settings on printer before printing.
The aspect ratio of pictures is different from that of paper used for printing.
If printing in shop, check if 16:9 sizes can be printed.
299
SQW0721
Others
Q&A Troubleshooting
Others
The lens makes a clicking noise.
When the camera is turned on or off, the lens is moved, or an aperture operation is performed,
such a noise may be heard. This is not a malfunction.
When the brightness changes after a zooming operation or moving the camera, the lens may make
a noise while adjusting the aperture. This is not a malfunction.
Zooming stops instantaneously.
When using the Extended Optical Zoom, the zooming action will stop temporarily. This is not a
malfunction.
Red lamp illuminated when pressing shutter button halfway in dark locations.
[AF Assist Lamp] is set to [ON] (→191).
Camera is hot.
Camera may become a little warm during use, but this does not affect performance or quality.
Clock is incorrect.
If you do not use the camera for a long time, the clock may be reset.
Reset the clock (→29).
When using zoom, picture becomes slightly warped and the edges of the subject become
colored.
Pictures may be slightly warped or colored around the edges, depending on the zoom ratio, but this
is not a fault.
300
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
When in use
Keep this unit as far away as possible from electromagnetic equipment (such as
microwave ovens, TVs, video games etc.).
• If you use this unit on top of or near a TV, the pictures and/or sound on this unit may
be disrupted by electromagnetic wave radiation.
• Do not use this unit near cell phones because doing so may result in noise adversely
affecting the pictures and/or sound.
• Recorded data may be damaged, or pictures may be distorted, by strong magnetic
fields created by speakers or large motors.
• Electromagnetic wave radiation may adversely affect this unit, disturbing the pictures
and/or sound.
• If this unit is adversely affected by electromagnetic equipment and stops functioning
properly, turn this unit off and remove the battery or disconnect AC adaptor (supplied)/
AC adaptor (optional). Then reinsert the battery or reconnect AC adaptor and turn this
unit on.
Do not use this unit near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines.
• If you record near radio transmitters or high-voltage lines, the recorded pictures and/
or sound may be adversely affected.
Do not extend the supplied cord or cable.
Do not allow camera to come into contact with pesticides or volatile substances (can
cause surface damage or coating to peel).
Objects that may be influenced magnetically should be kept away from
the speaker or other magnetic parts of the camera.
• Magnetized objects such as bank cards, commuter passes, watches,
may be adversely affected by the magnetic influence.
Magnet
Never leave the camera and the battery in a car or on a car hood in the summer.
Doing so may cause leakage of the battery electrolyte, overheating, fire or a battery
explosion due to the high temperature.
301
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Caring for your camera
To clean your camera, remove the battery, the DC coupler (optional) or a card, or
disconnect the power plug from the outlet, and wipe with a soft, dry cloth.
Use a damp cloth to remove stubborn stains, before wiping with a dry cloth.
Do not use benzine, thinners, alcohol, or kitchen detergent, as these may damage the
outer casing and finish of the camera.
If using a chemically-treated cloth, read the supplied instructions carefully.
Do not touch the lens barrier.
Lens barrier
When not using for a while
Turn off the camera before removing battery and card (ensure that battery is removed
to prevent damage through over-discharge).
Do not leave in contact with rubber or plastic bags.
Store together with a drying agent (silica gel) if leaving in drawer, etc. Store batteries in
cool (15 °C to 25 °C (59 °F to 77 °F)) places with low humidity (40%RH to 60%RH) and
no major temperature changes.
Charge battery once per year and use completely before storing again.
Check all the parts before taking pictures when you have not used the camera for a
long period of time.
Monitor
Do not press hard on the monitor. This may cause uneven display and damage the
monitor.
In cold climates or other situations when the camera becomes cold, the monitor may
appear slightly darker than normal immediately after the camera is turned on. Normal
brightness will return once the internal components have warmed up.
The monitor is made with extremely high precision technology. However there may be
some dark or bright spots (red, blue or green) on the screen. This is not a malfunction.
The monitor screen is controlled with extremely high precision, but some pixels may
be inactive. The spots will not be recorded on pictures on a card.
302
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Lens
Do not press the lens with excessive force.
Images may appear slightly white if lens is dirty (fingerprints, etc.). Turn the camera on,
hold the extracted lens barrel with your fingers, and gently wipe the lens surface with a
soft, dry cloth.
Do not leave the camera with the lens facing the sun as rays of light from the sun may
cause it to malfunction. Also, be careful when placing the camera outside or near a
window.
Do not touch the lens barrier, as this may damage the lens. Be careful when removing
camera from bag, etc.
Battery
The battery is a rechargeable lithium ion battery.
This battery is easily affected by temperature and humidity, and is affected more when the
temperature is high or low.
The time required for charging varies depending on conditions of battery usage.
Charging takes longer at high or low temperatures and when the battery has not been
used in some time.
Battery will be warm during charging and for some time thereafter.
Battery will run out if not used for long periods of time, even after being charged.
Do not leave any metal items (such as clips) near the contact areas of the power plug.
Otherwise, a fire and/or electric shocks may be caused by short-circuiting or the
resulting heat generated.
Frequently charging up battery is not recommended.
(Frequently charging battery reduces maximum usage time and can cause battery to
expand.)
If available battery power is significantly reduced, battery is reaching end of lifespan.
Please purchase a new battery.
When charging:
• Wipe dirt from the battery terminal with a dry cloth.
• Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference).
Do not use a damaged or dented battery (especially connectors), e.g. by dropping (can
cause faults).
303
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
AC adaptor (supplied)
Keep at least 1 m (3.3 feet) away from AM radio (may cause radio interference).
The AC adaptor (supplied) may generate whirring sounds when it is being used. This is
not a malfunction.
After use, be sure to disconnect the power supply device from the electrical outlet. (A
very small amount of current is consumed if it is left connected.)
Memory cards
To prevent damage to cards and data
• Avoid high temperatures, direct sunlight, electromagnetic waves, and static electricity.
• Do not bend, drop, or expose to strong impacts.
• Put the card in the card case or the storage bag after use and when storing or
carrying the card.
• Do not touch terminals on reverse of card or allow them to become dirty or wet.
Recorded data may be damaged or lost if the camera breaks down due to inappropriate
handling. Panasonic will not be liable for any damage caused due to loss of recorded
data.
When disposing of/transferring memory cards
• If using the “format” or “delete” functions on your camera or computer, this only
changes the file management information, and does not completely delete the data
from within the memory card. When disposing of or transferring your memory cards,
we recommend physically destroying them, or using commercially available computer
data erasing software to completely delete the data from the card. Data within
memory cards should be managed responsibly.
When using a tripod or unipod
Do not apply excessive force or tighten screws when they are crooked. (This may
damage the camera, screw hole, or label.)
Ensure that the tripod is stable. (Refer to the tripod instructions.)
You may not be able to remove the card or the battery when using a tripod or unipod.
304
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Personal Information
To protect personal information, we recommend that you set a Wi-Fi password or a Wi-Fi
function lock. (→266, 267)
If names or birthdays are set in [Profile Setup] or in the [Face Recog.] function, keep in
mind that the camera and recorded pictures will contain personal information.
Be sure to pay special attention to the privacy, likeness rights, etc. of a subject and
take your own responsibility when you use the [Silent Mode], or use functions such
as writing the location information and changing the shutter noise, etc.
Disclaimer
• Data containing personal information can be altered or lost due to malfunction, static
electricity, accidents, breakdowns, repairs, or other operations.
Panasonic will not be liable for any damage that occurs, direct or indirect, as a result
of the alteration or loss of data containing personal information.
When ordering repairs or transferring/disposing of the camera
• After you make a note of the personal information, perform [Reset Wi-Fi Settings]/
[Delete account] to delete data containing personal information such as wireless LAN
connection settings that you registered or set in this unit. (→205, 258)
• To protect your personal information, please reset the settings. (→205)
• Remove the memory card from the camera.
• When ordering repairs, settings may be returned to the initial purchase state.
• If the above operations cannot be performed because of a camera malfunction,
consult with the dealer or nearest Service Center.
When transferring or disposing of your memory card, see “When disposing of/
transferring memory cards” in the previous section. (→303)
Uploading pictures to WEB services
• Pictures may contain personal information that can be used to identify the user, such
as titles, recording dates and times, and location information. Before uploading the
pictures to WEB services, check the pictures carefully for information that should not
be disclosed.
305
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
Wi-Fi function
Use the camera as a wireless LAN device
When using equipment or computer systems that require more reliable security than
wireless LAN devices, ensure that the appropriate measures are taken for safety designs
and defects for the systems used. Panasonic will not take any responsibility for any
damage that arises when using the camera for any purpose other than as a wireless LAN
device.
Use of the Wi-Fi function of this camera is presumed to be in countries where
this camera is sold
There is the risk that the camera violates the radio wave regulations if used in countries
other than those where this camera is sold, and Panasonic takes no responsibility for any
violations.
There is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be intercepted
Please note that there is the risk that data sent and received via radio waves may be
intercepted by a third party. We strongly recommend that you enable encryption in the
settings of your wireless access point to ensure information security.
Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or
interference
• Do not use the camera in areas with magnetic fields, static electricity or interference,
such as near microwave ovens. Radio waves may not reach the camera.
• Using the camera near devices such as microwave ovens or cordless telephones
that use the 2.4 GHz radio wave band may cause a decrease in performance in both
devices.
Do not connect to the wireless network you are not authorized to use
When the camera utilizes its Wi-Fi function, wireless networks will be searched
automatically. When this happens, wireless networks that you are not authorized to use
(SSID
*
) may be displayed, however do not attempt to connect to the network as it may be
considered as unauthorized access.
*
SSID refers to the name that is used to identify a network over a wireless LAN connection. If the
SSID matches for both devices, transmission is possible.
306
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
SDXC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
The terms HDMI and HDMI High-Definition Multimedia Interface, and the HDMI Logo are
trademarks or registered trademarks of HDMI Licensing, LLC in the United States and other
countries.
HDAVI Control™ is a trademark of Panasonic Corporation.
“AVCHD”, “AVCHD Progressive” and the “AVCHD Progressive” logo are trademarks of
Panasonic Corporation and Sony Corporation.
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby and the double-D symbol are
trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Adobe is a trademark or registered trademark of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the United
States and/or other countries.
Pentium is a trademark of Intel Corporation in the U.S. and/or other countries.
Windows is either registered trademark or trademark of Microsoft Corporation in the United
States and/or other countries.
iMovie, Mac and Mac OS are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
iPad, iPhone, iPod, and iPod touch are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other
countries.
App Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
Android and Google Play are trademarks or registered trademarks of Google Inc.
The Wi-Fi CERTIFIED™ Logo is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
The Wi-Fi Protected Setup™ Identifier mark is a certification mark of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
“Wi-Fi
®
” and “Wi-Fi Direct
®
” are registered trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
“Wi-Fi Protected Setup™”, “WPA™”, and “WPA2™” are trademarks of Wi-Fi Alliance
®
.
DLNA, the DLNA Logo and DLNA CERTIFIED are trademarks, service marks, or certification
marks of the Digital Living Network Alliance.
QR Code is a registered trademark of DENSO WAVE INCORPORATED.
This product uses “DynaFont” from DynaComware Corporation. DynaFont is a registered
trademark of DynaComware Taiwan Inc.
Other names, company names, and product names mentioned in these instructions are
trademarks or registered trademarks of the companies concerned.
307
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
This product is licensed under the AVC Patent Portfolio License for the personal use of a consumer
or other uses in which it does not receive remuneration to (i) encode video in compliance with
the AVC Standard (“AVC Video”) and/or (ii) decode AVC Video that was encoded by a consumer
engaged in a personal activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed to provide AVC
Video. No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use. Additional information may be
obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C.
See http://www.mpegla.com
308
SQW0721
Others
Usage cautions and notes
This product incorporates the following software:
(1) the software developed independently by or for Panasonic Corporation,
(2) the software owned by third party and licensed to Panasonic Corporation, and/or
(3) open source software
The software categorized as (3) is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY, without even the implied warranty of
MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE.
Please refer to the detailed terms and conditions thereof displayed by selecting
[MENU/SET] → [Setup] → [Version Disp.] → [Software info].
26

Hulp nodig? Stel uw vraag in het forum

Spelregels

Misbruik melden

Gebruikershandleiding.com neemt misbruik van zijn services uitermate serieus. U kunt hieronder aangeven waarom deze vraag ongepast is. Wij controleren de vraag en zonodig wordt deze verwijderd.

Product:

Bijvoorbeeld antisemitische inhoud, racistische inhoud, of materiaal dat gewelddadige fysieke handelingen tot gevolg kan hebben.

Bijvoorbeeld een creditcardnummer, een persoonlijk identificatienummer, of een geheim adres. E-mailadressen en volledige namen worden niet als privégegevens beschouwd.

Spelregels forum

Om tot zinvolle vragen te komen hanteren wij de volgende spelregels:

Belangrijk! Als er een antwoord wordt gegeven op uw vraag, dan is het voor de gever van het antwoord nuttig om te weten als u er wel (of niet) mee geholpen bent! Wij vragen u dus ook te reageren op een antwoord.

Belangrijk! Antwoorden worden ook per e-mail naar abonnees gestuurd. Laat uw emailadres achter op deze site, zodat u op de hoogte blijft. U krijgt dan ook andere vragen en antwoorden te zien.

Abonneren

Abonneer u voor het ontvangen van emails voor uw Panasonic DMC-LX10 bij:


U ontvangt een email met instructies om u voor één of beide opties in te schrijven.


Ontvang uw handleiding per email

Vul uw emailadres in en ontvang de handleiding van Panasonic DMC-LX10 in de taal/talen: Engels als bijlage per email.

De handleiding is 10,57 mb groot.

 

U ontvangt de handleiding per email binnen enkele minuten. Als u geen email heeft ontvangen, dan heeft u waarschijnlijk een verkeerd emailadres ingevuld of is uw mailbox te vol. Daarnaast kan het zijn dat uw internetprovider een maximum heeft aan de grootte per email. Omdat hier een handleiding wordt meegestuurd, kan het voorkomen dat de email groter is dan toegestaan bij uw provider.

Stel vragen via chat aan uw handleiding

Stel uw vraag over deze PDF

Andere handleiding(en) van Panasonic DMC-LX10

Panasonic DMC-LX10 Snelstart handleiding - English - 72 pagina's


Uw handleiding is per email verstuurd. Controleer uw email

Als u niet binnen een kwartier uw email met handleiding ontvangen heeft, kan het zijn dat u een verkeerd emailadres heeft ingevuld of dat uw emailprovider een maximum grootte per email heeft ingesteld die kleiner is dan de grootte van de handleiding.

Er is een email naar u verstuurd om uw inschrijving definitief te maken.

Controleer uw email en volg de aanwijzingen op om uw inschrijving definitief te maken

U heeft geen emailadres opgegeven

Als u de handleiding per email wilt ontvangen, vul dan een geldig emailadres in.

Uw vraag is op deze pagina toegevoegd

Wilt u een email ontvangen bij een antwoord en/of nieuwe vragen? Vul dan hier uw emailadres in.



Info